blob: a270d69487e668d7034369a3137e097724cbf53a [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
437 - chroot
438 - daemon
439 - gid
440 - group
441 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100442 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200443 - nbproc
444 - pidfile
445 - uid
446 - ulimit-n
447 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200448 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200449 - node
450 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100451 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100452
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200453 * Performance tuning
454 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200455 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100456 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200457 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200458 - noepoll
459 - nokqueue
460 - nopoll
461 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100462 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200463 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200464 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200465 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200466 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100467 - tune.maxaccept
468 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200469 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200470 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100471 - tune.rcvbuf.client
472 - tune.rcvbuf.server
473 - tune.sndbuf.client
474 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100475
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 * Debugging
477 - debug
478 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200479
480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004813.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200482------------------------------------
483
484chroot <jail dir>
485 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
486 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
487 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
488 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
489 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
490 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100491
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200492daemon
493 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
494 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
495 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
496
497gid <number>
498 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
499 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
500 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
501 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503group <group name>
504 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
505 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100506
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200507log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
509 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100510 configured with "log global".
511
512 <address> can be one of:
513
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100514 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100515 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
516 port).
517
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100518 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
519 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
520 port).
521
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100522 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
523 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
524 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
525 writeable).
526
527 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200528
529 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
530 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
531 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
532
533 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200534 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
535 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
536 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
537 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
538 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
539 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200541 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100543log-send-hostname [<string>]
544 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
545 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
546 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
547 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
548 the logs.
549
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000550log-tag <string>
551 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
552 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
553 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
554 running on the same host.
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556nbproc <number>
557 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
558 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
559 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
560 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
561 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
562
563pidfile <pidfile>
564 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
565 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
566 starting the process. See also "daemon".
567
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200568stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
569 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
570 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
571 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
572 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200573
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200574 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
575 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
576 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200577
578stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
579 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
580 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100581 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200582
583stats maxconn <connections>
584 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
585 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
586
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587uid <number>
588 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
589 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
590 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
591 one. See also "gid" and "user".
592
593ulimit-n <number>
594 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
595 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
596 option.
597
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100598unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
599 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
600
601 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
602 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
603 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
604 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
605 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
606 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
607 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
608 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
609 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
610 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
611
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612user <user name>
613 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
614 See also "uid" and "group".
615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200616node <name>
617 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
618
619 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
620 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
621 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
622 traffic.
623
624description <text>
625 Add a text that describes the instance.
626
627 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
628 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
629 "<" and ">" characters.
630
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006323.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633-----------------------
634
635maxconn <number>
636 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
637 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
638 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
639 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
640
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200641maxconnrate <number>
642 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
643 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
644 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
645 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
646 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
647 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
648 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
649 fairness.
650
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100651maxpipes <number>
652 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
653 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
654 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
655 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
656 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
657 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
658
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200659maxsslconn <number>
660 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
661 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
662 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
663 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
664 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
665 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
666 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200668noepoll
669 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
670 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
671 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
672
673nokqueue
674 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
675 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
676 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
677
678nopoll
679 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
680 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100681 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200682 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
683 "nokqueue".
684
685nosepoll
686 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
687 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
688 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
689
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100690nosplice
691 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
692 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
693 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100694 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100695 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
696 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
697 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
698 "option splice-response".
699
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200700spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
701 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
702 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
703 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
704 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
705 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
706
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200707tune.bufsize <number>
708 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
709 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
710 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
711 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
712 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
713 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
714 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
715 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
716
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200717tune.chksize <number>
718 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
719 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
720 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
721 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
722 checks whenever possible.
723
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200724tune.http.maxhdr <number>
725 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
726 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
727 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
728 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
729 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
730 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
731 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
732 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
733 limit too high.
734
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100735tune.maxaccept <number>
736 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
737 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
738 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100739 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100740 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
741 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100742 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100743 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
744
745tune.maxpollevents <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
747 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
748 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
749 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
750 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
751
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200752tune.maxrewrite <number>
753 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
754 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
755 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
756 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
757 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
758 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
759 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
760 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
761 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
762 bufsize.
763
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200764tune.pipesize <number>
765 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
766 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
767 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
768 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
769 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
770 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
771
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100772tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
773tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
774 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
775 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
776 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
777 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
778 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
779 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
780 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
781
782tune.sndbuf.client <number>
783tune.sndbuf.server <number>
784 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
785 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
786 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
787 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
788 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
789 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
790 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
791 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
792 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
793 notifying haproxy again.
794
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007963.3. Debugging
797--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798
799debug
800 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
801 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
802 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
803 system startup.
804
805quiet
806 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
807 line argument "-q".
808
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008103.4. Userlists
811--------------
812It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
813http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
814it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
815
816userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100817 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100818 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
819
820group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100821 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100822 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
823 proceeded by "users" keyword.
824
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100825user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
826 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100827 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
828 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100829 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
830 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100831 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
832 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
833
834
835 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100836 userlist L1
837 group G1 users tiger,scott
838 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100839
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100840 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
841 user scott insecure-password elgato
842 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100843
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100844 userlist L2
845 group G1
846 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100847
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100848 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
849 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
850 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100851
852 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200854
8553.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200856----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200857It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
858haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
859pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
860identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
861or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
862Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
863known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
864the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
865process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
866during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
867tables.
868
869peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400870 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200871 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
872
873peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
874 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
875 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
876 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
877 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
878 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
879 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
880
881 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
882 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
883
884 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
885 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
886 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
887 across all peers.
888
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200889 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200890 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100891 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
892 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
893 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200894
895 backend mybackend
896 mode tcp
897 balance roundrobin
898 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
899 stick on src
900
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100901 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
902 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200903
904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009054. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200906----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100907
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200908Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
909 - defaults <name>
910 - frontend <name>
911 - backend <name>
912 - listen <name>
913
914A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
915its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
916section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100917section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918
919A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
920connections.
921
922A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
923to forward incoming connections.
924
925A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
926parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100928All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
929'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
930case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
931
932Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
933logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
934proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
935However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
936name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
937
938Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
939and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100940bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100941protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
942modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
943arbitrary criteria.
944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009464.1. Proxy keywords matrix
947--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200949The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
950limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
951they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
952limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100953marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200954option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200955and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
956with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
957specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100958
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
961------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
962acl - X X X
963appsession - - X X
964backlog X X X -
965balance X - X X
966bind - X X -
967bind-process X X X X
968block - X X X
969capture cookie - X X -
970capture request header - X X -
971capture response header - X X -
972clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
973contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
974cookie X - X X
975default-server X - X X
976default_backend X X X -
977description - X X X
978disabled X X X X
979dispatch - - X X
980enabled X X X X
981errorfile X X X X
982errorloc X X X X
983errorloc302 X X X X
984-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
985errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200986force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100987fullconn X - X X
988grace X X X X
989hash-type X - X X
990http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100991http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200992http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100993http-request - X X X
994id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200995ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200996log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100997maxconn X X X -
998mode X X X X
999monitor fail - X X -
1000monitor-net X X X -
1001monitor-uri X X X -
1002option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1003option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1004option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1005option allbackups (*) X - X X
1006option checkcache (*) X - X X
1007option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1008option contstats (*) X X X -
1009option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1010option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1011option forceclose (*) X X X X
1012-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1013option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001014option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001015option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001016option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1017option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1018option httpchk X - X X
1019option httpclose (*) X X X X
1020option httplog X X X X
1021option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001022option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001023option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001024option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1025option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1026option logasap (*) X X X -
1027option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001028option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001029option nolinger (*) X X X X
1030option originalto X X X X
1031option persist (*) X - X X
1032option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001033option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001034option smtpchk X - X X
1035option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1036option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1037option splice-request (*) X X X X
1038option splice-response (*) X X X X
1039option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1040option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1041-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1042option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1043option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1044option tcpka X X X X
1045option tcplog X X X X
1046option transparent (*) X - X X
1047persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1048rate-limit sessions X X X -
1049redirect - X X X
1050redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1051redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1052reqadd - X X X
1053reqallow - X X X
1054reqdel - X X X
1055reqdeny - X X X
1056reqiallow - X X X
1057reqidel - X X X
1058reqideny - X X X
1059reqipass - X X X
1060reqirep - X X X
1061reqisetbe - X X X
1062reqitarpit - X X X
1063reqpass - X X X
1064reqrep - X X X
1065-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1066reqsetbe - X X X
1067reqtarpit - X X X
1068retries X - X X
1069rspadd - X X X
1070rspdel - X X X
1071rspdeny - X X X
1072rspidel - X X X
1073rspideny - X X X
1074rspirep - X X X
1075rsprep - X X X
1076server - - X X
1077source X - X X
1078srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001079stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001080stats auth X - X X
1081stats enable X - X X
1082stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001083stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001084stats realm X - X X
1085stats refresh X - X X
1086stats scope X - X X
1087stats show-desc X - X X
1088stats show-legends X - X X
1089stats show-node X - X X
1090stats uri X - X X
1091-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1092stick match - - X X
1093stick on - - X X
1094stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001095stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001096stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001097tcp-request connection - X X -
1098tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001099tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001100tcp-response content - - X X
1101tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001102timeout check X - X X
1103timeout client X X X -
1104timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1105timeout connect X - X X
1106timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1107timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1108timeout http-request X X X X
1109timeout queue X - X X
1110timeout server X - X X
1111timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1112timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001113timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001114transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001115unique-id-format X X X -
1116unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001117use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001118use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001119------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1120 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011234.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1124---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001125
1126This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1127
1128
1129acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1130 Declare or complete an access list.
1131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1132 no | yes | yes | yes
1133 Example:
1134 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1135 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1136 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001138 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001139
1140
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001141appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1142 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001143 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1145 no | no | yes | yes
1146 Arguments :
1147 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1148 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1149
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001150 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001151 checked in each cookie value.
1152
1153 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1154 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1155 milliseconds.
1156
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001157 request-learn
1158 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1159 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1160 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1161 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1162 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1163 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1164
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001165 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1166 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1167 data following this prefix.
1168
1169 Example :
1170 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1171
1172 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1173 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1174
1175 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1176 2 modes are currently supported :
1177 - path-parameters :
1178 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1179 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1180 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1181 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1182 - query-string :
1183 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1184 query string.
1185
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001186 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1187 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1188 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1189 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001190 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1191 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1192 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001193 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1194 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1195
1196 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1197
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001198 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1199 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1200 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1201
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001202 Example :
1203 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1204
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001205 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1206 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001207
1208
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001209backlog <conns>
1210 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1212 yes | yes | yes | no
1213 Arguments :
1214 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1215 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001216 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001217
1218 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1219 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1220 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1221 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1222 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1223 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1224 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1225 backlog parameter.
1226
1227 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1228 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1229 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1230
1231 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1232
1233
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001234balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001235balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001236 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1238 yes | no | yes | yes
1239 Arguments :
1240 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1241 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1242 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1243 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1244
1245 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1246 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1247 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1248 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001249 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1250 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1251 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1252 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1253 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1254 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1255 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1256 it, so that you don't worry.
1257
1258 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1259 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1260 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1261 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1262 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1263 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1264 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1265 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001266
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001267 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1268 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1269 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1270 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1271 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1272 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1273 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1274 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1275
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001276 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1277 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1278 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1279 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001280 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001281 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1282 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1283 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1284 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1285 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001286 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1287 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1288 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1289 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1290 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1291 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001292
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001293 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1294 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1295 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1296 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1297 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1298 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1299 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1300 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001301 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001302 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001303 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1304 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1305 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001306
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001307 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1308 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1309 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1310 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1311 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1312 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1313 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1314 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1315 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1316 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1317 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1318 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001319
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001320 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001321 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1322 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1323 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1324 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1325 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1326 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1327 URIs start with a leading "/".
1328
1329 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1330 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1331 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1332 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1333
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001334 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001335 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1336
1337 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001338 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1339 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1340 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1341 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1342 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1343 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1344 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1345 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1346 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1347 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1348 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1349 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1350 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1351 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1352 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1353 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1354 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1355 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1356 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001357
1358 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1359 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1360 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1361 server will receive the request.
1362
1363 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1364 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1365 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1366 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1367 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001368 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1369 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1370 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001371
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001372 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1373 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1374 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1375 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1376 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001378 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001379 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1380 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1381 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1382
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001383 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1384 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1385 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1386
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001387 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001388 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001389 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1390 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1391 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1392 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1393 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1394 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001395 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001396 used instead.
1397
1398 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1399 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1400 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1401 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1402
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001403 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1404 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1405 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1406
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001407 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001408
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001409 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001410 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1411 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001412
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001413 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001414 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001415
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001416 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1417 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1418 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001419
1420 Examples :
1421 balance roundrobin
1422 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001423 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001424 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1425 balance hdr(host)
1426 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001427
1428 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1429 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001431 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001432 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1433 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1434 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1435 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1436
1437 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1438 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1439 defaults to 16 kB.
1440
1441 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1442 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1443
1444 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1445 Round Robin.
1446
1447 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1448 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1449 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1450 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1451
1452 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1453
1454 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001455 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001456 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1457 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1458 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001460 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1461 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001462
1463
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001464bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1465bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1468 no | yes | yes | no
1469 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001470 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1471 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1472 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1473 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001474 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001475
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001476 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1477 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001478 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1479 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1480 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001481 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1482 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1483 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1484 the range.
1485
1486 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1487 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1488 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1489 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1490 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1491 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1492 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001493 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001494 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001496 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1497 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1498 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1499 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1500 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1501 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1502 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1503 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1504
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001505 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1506 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1507 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1508 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001509
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001510 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1511 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1512 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1513 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1514 in a frontend.
1515
1516 Example :
1517 listen http_proxy
1518 bind :80,:443
1519 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001520 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001521
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001522 listen http_https_proxy
1523 bind :80
1524 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem prefer-server-ciphers
1525
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001526 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001527 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001528
1529
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001530bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1531 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1533 yes | yes | yes | yes
1534 Arguments :
1535 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1536 may be used to override a default value.
1537
1538 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1539 option may be combined with other numbers.
1540
1541 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1542 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1543 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1544 missing from all processes.
1545
1546 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1547 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1548 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1549 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1550
1551 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1552 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1553 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1554 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1555 and 'even' instances.
1556
1557 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1558 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1559 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1560 32.
1561
1562 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1563 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1564
1565 Example :
1566 listen app_ip1
1567 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001568 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001569
1570 listen app_ip2
1571 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001572 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001573
1574 listen management
1575 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001576 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001577
1578 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1579
1580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001581block { if | unless } <condition>
1582 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1584 no | yes | yes | yes
1585
1586 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1587 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001588 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001589 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001590 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1591 "block" statements per instance.
1592
1593 Example:
1594 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1595 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1596 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1597 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001599 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
1601
1602capture cookie <name> len <length>
1603 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1605 no | yes | yes | no
1606 Arguments :
1607 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1608 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1609 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1610 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1611 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1612
1613 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1614 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1615 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1616 right if it exceeds <length>.
1617
1618 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1619 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1620 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1621 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1622
1623 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1624 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1625 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1626
1627 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1628 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1629 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1630 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001631 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1633
1634 Example:
1635 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1636
1637 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001638 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639
1640
1641capture request header <name> len <length>
1642 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1644 no | yes | yes | no
1645 Arguments :
1646 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001647 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001648 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1649 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1650 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1651
1652 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1653 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1654 it exceeds <length>.
1655
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001656 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1658 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001659 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1660 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1661 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1662 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001663 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001664 environments to find where the request came from.
1665
1666 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1667 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1668 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1669 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001670
1671 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1672 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1673 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1674 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1675
1676 Example:
1677 capture request header Host len 15
1678 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1679 capture request header Referrer len 15
1680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001681 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682 about logging.
1683
1684
1685capture response header <name> len <length>
1686 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1688 no | yes | yes | no
1689 Arguments :
1690 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001691 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001692 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1693 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1694 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1695
1696 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1697 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1698 it exceeds <length>.
1699
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001700 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1702 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1703 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001704 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1705 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1706 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1707 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001708
1709 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1710 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1711 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1712 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1713
1714 Example:
1715 capture response header Content-length len 9
1716 capture response header Location len 15
1717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001718 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 about logging.
1720
1721
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001722clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001723 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1725 yes | yes | yes | no
1726 Arguments :
1727 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1728 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1729 as explained at the top of this document.
1730
1731 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1732 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1733 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1734 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1735 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1736 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1737 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1738 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001739 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1741 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1742
1743 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1744 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1745 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1746 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1747 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1748 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1749
1750 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1751 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1752
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001753 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1754 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001755
1756
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001757contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1760 yes | no | yes | yes
1761 Arguments :
1762 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1764 as explained at the top of this document.
1765
1766 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001767 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001768 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1770 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1771 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1772 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1773
1774 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1775 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1776 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1777 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1778 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1779 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1780
1781 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1782 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1783 instead.
1784
1785 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1786 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1787
1788
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001789cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001790 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1791 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001792 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1794 yes | no | yes | yes
1795 Arguments :
1796 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1797 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1798 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1799 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1800 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1801 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1802 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1803 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1804 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1805
1806 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1807 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1808 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1809 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1810 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1811 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1812 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1813 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1814 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1815 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1816 "insert" and "prefix".
1817
1818 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001819 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001820
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001821 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001822 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1823 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1824 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1825 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1826 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1827 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1828 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1829 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1830 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1831 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832
1833 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1834 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1835 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1836 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1837 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1838 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1839 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1840 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1841 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1842 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001843 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1844 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1845 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001846
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001847 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1848 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1849 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001850 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1851 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1852 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1853 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001854 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1855 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1856 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
1858 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1859 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1860 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1861 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1862 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1863 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1864 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1865 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1866 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1867
1868 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1869 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1870 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1871 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1872 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1873 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1874 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1875 persistence cookie in the cache.
1876 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1877
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001878 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1879 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1880 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1881 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1882 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1883 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1884 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1885 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1886 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1887 they logout.
1888
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001889 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1890 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1891 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1892 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1893
1894 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1895 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1896 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1897 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
1898 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
1899 this attribute.
1900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001901 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001902 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001903 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1904 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1905 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1906 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1907 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1908 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001909
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001910 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1911 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1912 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1913 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1914 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1915 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1916 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1917 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1918 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1919 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1920 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1921 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1922 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1923 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1924 the site.
1925
1926 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1927 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1928 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1929 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1930 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1931 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1932 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1933 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1934 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1935 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1936 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1937 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1938 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1939 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1940 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1941 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1942
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1944 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1945 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1946 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948 Examples :
1949 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1950 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1951 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001952 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001953
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001954 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001955 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001958default-server [param*]
1959 Change default options for a server in a backend
1960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1961 yes | no | yes | yes
1962 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001963 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1964 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1965 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1966 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001967
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001968 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001969 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1970
1971 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001972
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974default_backend <backend>
1975 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1977 yes | yes | yes | no
1978 Arguments :
1979 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1980
1981 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1982 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1983 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1984 will catch all undetermined requests.
1985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986 Example :
1987
1988 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1989 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1990 default_backend dynamic
1991
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001992 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1993
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994
1995disabled
1996 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1998 yes | yes | yes | yes
1999 Arguments : none
2000
2001 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2002 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2003 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2004 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2005 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2006 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2007 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2008
2009 See also : "enabled"
2010
2011
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002012dispatch <address>:<port>
2013 Set a default server address
2014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2015 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002016 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002017
2018 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2019 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2020 during start-up.
2021
2022 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2023 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2024 possible with normal servers.
2025
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002026 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002027 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2028 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2029 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2030 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2031
2032 See also : "server"
2033
2034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035enabled
2036 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2038 yes | yes | yes | yes
2039 Arguments : none
2040
2041 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2042 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2043
2044 See also : "disabled"
2045
2046
2047errorfile <code> <file>
2048 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2050 yes | yes | yes | yes
2051 Arguments :
2052 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002053 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054
2055 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002056 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002058 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2059 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
2061 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2062 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2063 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2064
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002065 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002067 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2068 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2069 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2070 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2071
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002072 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2073 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2074 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2075 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2076 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2077 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002079 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2080 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2081 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002082 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2084
2085 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2086
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002087 Example :
2088 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2089 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2090 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002092
2093errorloc <code> <url>
2094errorloc302 <code> <url>
2095 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2097 yes | yes | yes | yes
2098 Arguments :
2099 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002100 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002101
2102 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2103 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2104 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2105 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2106 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2107
2108 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2109 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2110 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2111
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002112 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2113
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002114 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2115 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2116 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2117 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2118 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2119 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2120 request.
2121
2122 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2123
2124
2125errorloc303 <code> <url>
2126 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2128 yes | yes | yes | yes
2129 Arguments :
2130 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2131 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2132
2133 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2134 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2135 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2136 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2137 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2138
2139 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2140 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2141 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2142
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002143 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2144
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002145 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2146 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2147 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2148 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002149 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002150
2151 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2152
2153
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002154force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2155 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2157 no | yes | yes | yes
2158
2159 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2160 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2161 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2162 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2163 marked down for maintenance operations.
2164
2165 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2166 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2167 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2168 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2169 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2170 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2171 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2172 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2173 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2174
2175 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2176 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2177 is used.
2178
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002179 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002180 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002181
2182
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002183fullconn <conns>
2184 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2186 yes | no | yes | yes
2187 Arguments :
2188 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2189 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2190
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002191 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002192 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002193 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002194 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2195 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2196 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2197 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2198 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002199 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002200
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002201 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2202 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2203 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2204
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002205 Example :
2206 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2207 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2208 # connections.
2209 backend dynamic
2210 fullconn 10000
2211 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2212 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2213
2214 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2215
2216
2217grace <time>
2218 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002220 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002221 Arguments :
2222 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2223 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2224 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2225
2226 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2227 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002228 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002229 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2230
2231 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2232 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2233 simplify it.
2234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002235
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002236hash-type <method>
2237 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2239 yes | no | yes | yes
2240 Arguments :
2241 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2242 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2243 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2244 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2245 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2246 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2247 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2248 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2249 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2250
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002251 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2252 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2253 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2254 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2255 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2256 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2257 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2258 this value.
2259
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002260 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2261 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2262 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2263 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2264 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2265 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2266 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2267 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2268 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2269 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2270 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2271 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2272 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2273
2274 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2275
2276 See also : "balance", "server"
2277
2278
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279http-check disable-on-404
2280 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002282 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002283 Arguments : none
2284
2285 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2286 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2287 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2288 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2289 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2290 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2291 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2292 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002293 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2294 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2295 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2296
2297 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2298
2299
2300http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002301 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002303 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002304 Arguments :
2305 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2306 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002307 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002308 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2309 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2310 details on the supported keywords.
2311
2312 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2313 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2314 with the usual backslash ('\').
2315
2316 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2317 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2318 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2319 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2320 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2321
2322 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002323 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002324 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2325 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2326 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2327
2328 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002329 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002330 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2331 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2332 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2333 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2334
2335 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002336 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002337 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2338 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2339 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2340 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2341 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2342 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2343 trace).
2344
2345 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002346 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002347 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2348 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2349 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2350 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2351 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2352 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2353
2354 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2355 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2356 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2357 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2358 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2359 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2360 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2361 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2362
2363 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2364 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2365
2366 Examples :
2367 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002368 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002369
2370 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002371 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002372
2373 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002374 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002375
2376 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002377 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002379 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002380
2381
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002382http-check send-state
2383 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2385 yes | no | yes | yes
2386 Arguments : none
2387
2388 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2389 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2390 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2391 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2392 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2393
2394 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2395 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2396 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2397 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2398 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2399 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2400 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2401 checked in multiple backends.
2402
2403 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2404 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2405
2406 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2407 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2408 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2409 one fails.
2410
2411 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2412 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2413 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2414
2415 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2416 server's queue.
2417
2418 Example of a header received by the application server :
2419 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2420 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2421
2422 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2423
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002424http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002425 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002426 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2427
2428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2429 no | yes | yes | yes
2430
2431 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2432 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2433 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002434 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2435 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002436 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2437
2438 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2439 instance.
2440
2441 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002442 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2443 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2444 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002445
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002446 http-request allow if nagios
2447 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2448 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2449 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002450
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002451 Example:
2452 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002453
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002454 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002455
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002456 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2457 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002458
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002459http-send-name-header [<header>]
2460 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2461
2462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2463 yes | no | yes | yes
2464
2465 Arguments :
2466
2467 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2468
2469 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2470 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2471 is added with the header string proved.
2472
2473 See also : "server"
2474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002475id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002476 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2478 no | yes | yes | yes
2479 Arguments : none
2480
2481 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2482 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2483 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002484
2485
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002486ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2487 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 no | yes | yes | yes
2490
2491 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2492 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2493 and running).
2494
2495 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2496 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2497 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2498 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2499 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2500
2501 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2502 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2503
2504 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2505 "unless" condition is met.
2506
2507 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2508
2509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002510log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002511log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002512no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002513 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2515 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002516
2517 Prefix :
2518 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2519 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2520 prefix does not allow arguments.
2521
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002522 Arguments :
2523 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2524 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2525 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2526 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2527 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2528 parameter.
2529
2530 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2531 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2532
2533 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2534 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2535 standard syslog port).
2536
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002537 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2538 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2539 standard syslog port).
2540
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002541 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2542 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2543 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2544 appropriately writeable).
2545
2546 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2547
2548 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2549 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2550 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2551
2552 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2553 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2554 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002555 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2556 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2557 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2558 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2559 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002560
2561 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2562
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002563 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2564 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2565 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002566
2567 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2568 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2569 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2570 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2571
2572 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2573 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002574
2575 Example :
2576 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002577 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2578 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002579
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002580log-format <string>
2581 Allows you to custom a log line.
2582
2583 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002585
2586maxconn <conns>
2587 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2589 yes | yes | yes | no
2590 Arguments :
2591 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2592 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2593 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2594 closes.
2595
2596 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2597 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2598 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2599 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2600 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2601 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2602 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2603 properly tuned.
2604
2605 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2606 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2607 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2608
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002609 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2610
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002611 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2612
2613
2614mode { tcp|http|health }
2615 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2617 yes | yes | yes | yes
2618 Arguments :
2619 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2620 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2621 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2622 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2623
2624 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2625 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2626 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2627 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2628 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2629
2630 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2631 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2632 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2633 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2634 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2635 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2636
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002637 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2638 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2639 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002640
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002641 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002642 defaults http_instances
2643 mode http
2644
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002645 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002647
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002648monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2651 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652 Arguments :
2653 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2654 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002655 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002656 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2657 backend and its backup.
2658
2659 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2660 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2661 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2662 servers in a list of backends.
2663
2664 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2665 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2666 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2667 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2668 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2669 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2670 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002671 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2672 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673
2674 Example:
2675 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002676 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2678 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2679 monitor-uri /site_alive
2680 monitor fail if site_dead
2681
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002682 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002683
2684
2685monitor-net <source>
2686 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2688 yes | yes | yes | no
2689 Arguments :
2690 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2691 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2692 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2693 followed by a mask.
2694
2695 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2696 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002697 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002698 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2699
2700 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2701 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2702 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2703 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2704 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2705
2706 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2707 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2708 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2709 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2710 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2711
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002712 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2713 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002714
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002715 Example :
2716 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2717 frontend www
2718 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2719
2720 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2721
2722
2723monitor-uri <uri>
2724 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2726 yes | yes | yes | no
2727 Arguments :
2728 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2729 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2730
2731 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2732 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2733 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2734 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2735 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2736 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2737 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2738 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2739
2740 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2741 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2742 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2743 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2744 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2745 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2746
2747 Example :
2748 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2749 frontend www
2750 mode http
2751 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2752
2753 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2754
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002755
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002756option abortonclose
2757no option abortonclose
2758 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2760 yes | no | yes | yes
2761 Arguments : none
2762
2763 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2764 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2765 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2766 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002767 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002768 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2769 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2770 encountered while delivering the response.
2771
2772 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2773 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2774 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2775 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2776 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2777 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002778 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002779 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002780 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002781 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2782 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2783 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2784
2785 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2786 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2787 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2788 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2789 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2790 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2791 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2792 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002793 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002794
2795 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2796 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2797
2798 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2799
2800
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002801option accept-invalid-http-request
2802no option accept-invalid-http-request
2803 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2805 yes | yes | yes | no
2806 Arguments : none
2807
2808 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2809 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2810 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2811 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2812 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2813 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2814 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2815 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002816 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2817 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2818 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2819 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2820 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2821 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002822
2823 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2824 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2825 been confirmed.
2826
2827 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2828 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002829 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2830 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002831 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2832
2833 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2834 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2835
2836 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2837 stats socket.
2838
2839
2840option accept-invalid-http-response
2841no option accept-invalid-http-response
2842 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 yes | no | yes | yes
2845 Arguments : none
2846
2847 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2848 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2849 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2850 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2851 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2852 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2853 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2854 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2855 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2856
2857 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2858 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2859 been confirmed.
2860
2861 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2862 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2863 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2864 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2865
2866 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2867 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2868
2869 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2870 stats socket.
2871
2872
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002873option allbackups
2874no option allbackups
2875 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2877 yes | no | yes | yes
2878 Arguments : none
2879
2880 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2881 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2882 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2883 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2884 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2885 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2886 order between the backup servers anymore.
2887
2888 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2889 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2890
2891 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2892 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2893
2894
2895option checkcache
2896no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002897 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2899 yes | no | yes | yes
2900 Arguments : none
2901
2902 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2903 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002904 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002905 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2906 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002907 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002908
2909 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002910 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002911 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002912 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2913 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002914 to the client are :
2915 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002916 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002917 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002918 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2919 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2920 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2921 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2922 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2923 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2924 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2925 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2926 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2927 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2928 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2929
2930 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002931 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002932 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002933 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002934 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2935
2936 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2937 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002938 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002939 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2940
2941 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2942 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2943
2944
2945option clitcpka
2946no option clitcpka
2947 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2949 yes | yes | yes | no
2950 Arguments : none
2951
2952 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2953 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2954 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2955 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2956
2957 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2958 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2959 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2960 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2961
2962 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2963 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2964 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2965 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2966 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2967
2968 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2969
2970 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2971 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2972 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2973
2974 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2975 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2976
2977 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2978
2979
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002980option contstats
2981 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 yes | yes | yes | no
2984 Arguments : none
2985
2986 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2987 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2988 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2989 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2990 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2991 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2992 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2993
2994
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002995option dontlog-normal
2996no option dontlog-normal
2997 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2999 yes | yes | yes | no
3000 Arguments : none
3001
3002 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3003 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3004 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3005 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3006 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3007 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3008 logged.
3009
3010 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3011 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3012 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003014 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003015 logging.
3016
3017
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003018option dontlognull
3019no option dontlognull
3020 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3022 yes | yes | yes | no
3023 Arguments : none
3024
3025 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3026 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3027 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3028 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3029 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3030 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3031 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3032
3033 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3034 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3035 would not be logged.
3036
3037 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3038 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003040 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003041
3042
3043option forceclose
3044no option forceclose
3045 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003047 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003048 Arguments : none
3049
3050 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3051 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3052 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3053 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3054 global session times in the logs.
3055
3056 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003057 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003058 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3059 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3060 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3061 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003062
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003063 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3064 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3065 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3066
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3069
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003070 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003071
3072
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003073option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003074 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3076 yes | yes | yes | yes
3077 Arguments :
3078 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3079 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003080 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003081 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003082
3083 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3084 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3085 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3086 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3087 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3088 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3089 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003090 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3091 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3092 possible that the client has already brought one.
3093
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003094 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003095 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003096 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3097 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003098 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3099 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003100
3101 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3102 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3103 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3104 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3105 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3106 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3107 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3108
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003109 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3110 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3111 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3112 are under the control of the end-user.
3113
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003114 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003115 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3116 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003117 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3118 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3119 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003120
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003121 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3122 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3123 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3124 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3125 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003126
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003127 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003128 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3129 frontend www
3130 mode http
3131 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3132
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003133 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3134 backend www
3135 mode http
3136 option forwardfor header X-Client
3137
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003138 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3139 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003140
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003141
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003142option http-no-delay
3143no option http-no-delay
3144 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3146 yes | yes | yes | yes
3147 Arguments : none
3148
3149 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3150 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3151 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3152 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3153 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3154 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3155 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3156 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3157 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3158 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3159 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3160 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3161 affected.
3162
3163 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3164 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3165 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3166 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3167 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3168 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3169 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3170 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3171 latency environments.
3172
3173
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003174option http-pretend-keepalive
3175no option http-pretend-keepalive
3176 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3178 yes | yes | yes | yes
3179 Arguments : none
3180
3181 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3182 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3183 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3184 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3185 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3186 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3187 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3188 consider the response complete.
3189
3190 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3191 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3192 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3193 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3194 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3195 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3196
3197 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3198 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3199 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3200 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3201 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3202 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3203 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3204
3205 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3206 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003207 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003208 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3209 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003210
3211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3213
3214 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3215
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003216
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003217option http-server-close
3218no option http-server-close
3219 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3221 yes | yes | yes | yes
3222 Arguments : none
3223
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003224 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3225 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3226 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3227 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3228 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3229 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3230 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3231 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3232 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3233 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3234 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3235 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003236
3237 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3238 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3239 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3240 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003241 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3242 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003243
3244 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3245 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003246 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3247 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3248 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003249
3250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3252
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003253 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3254 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003255
3256
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003257option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003258no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003259 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3261 yes | yes | yes | no
3262 Arguments : none
3263
3264 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3265 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3266 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3267 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3268 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3269 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3270 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3271
3272 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3273 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3274 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3275 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3276 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3277 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3278 request along its whole life.
3279
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003280 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3281 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3282 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3283 front of an existing proxy.
3284
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003285 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3286
3287 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3288 http-server-close".
3289
3290
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003291option httpchk
3292option httpchk <uri>
3293option httpchk <method> <uri>
3294option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3295 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3297 yes | no | yes | yes
3298 Arguments :
3299 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3300 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3301 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3302 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3303 ones.
3304
3305 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3306 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3307 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3308
3309 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3310 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3311 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3312 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3313 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3314
3315 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3316 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3317 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3318 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3319 the lack of any response.
3320
3321 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3322
3323 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3324 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3325 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3326
3327 Examples :
3328 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3329 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3330 backend https_relay
3331 mode tcp
3332 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3333 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3334
3335 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003336 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3337 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003338
3339
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003340option httpclose
3341no option httpclose
3342 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3344 yes | yes | yes | yes
3345 Arguments : none
3346
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003347 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3348 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3349 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3350 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3351 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3352 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3353 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003354
3355 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003356 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003357 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3358 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3359 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3360 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3361 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003362
3363 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3364 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3365 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003366 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3367 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003368
3369 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3370 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3371
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003372 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3373 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003374
3375
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003376option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003377 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3379 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003380 Arguments :
3381 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3382 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3383 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3384 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3385 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003386
3387 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3388 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3389 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3390 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3391 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3392 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3393 ports.
3394
3395 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3396
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003397 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3398 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3399 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3400 by default.
3401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003402 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003403
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003404
3405option http_proxy
3406no option http_proxy
3407 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | yes | yes | yes
3410 Arguments : none
3411
3412 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3413 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3414 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3415 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3416 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3417
3418 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3419 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3420 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3421 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003422 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003423 be analyzed.
3424
3425 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3426 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3427
3428 Example :
3429 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3430 backend direct_forward
3431 option httpclose
3432 option http_proxy
3433
3434 See also : "option httpclose"
3435
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003436
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003437option independent-streams
3438no option independent-streams
3439 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3441 yes | yes | yes | yes
3442 Arguments : none
3443
3444 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3445 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3446 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3447 receive data or not.
3448
3449 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3450 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3451 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3452 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3453 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3454 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3455 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3456 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3457 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3458 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3459 socket buffers.
3460
3461 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3462 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3463 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3464 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3465 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3466
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003467 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3468 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3469 deprecated.
3470
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003471 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003472
3473
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003474option ldap-check
3475 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3477 yes | no | yes | yes
3478 Arguments : none
3479
3480 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3481 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3482 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3483 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3484
3485 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3486 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3487
3488 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3489 configure it.
3490
3491 Example :
3492 option ldap-check
3493
3494 See also : "option httpchk"
3495
3496
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003497option log-health-checks
3498no option log-health-checks
3499 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 yes | no | yes | yes
3502 Arguments : none
3503
3504 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3505 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3506 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3507 of additional information is limited.
3508
3509 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3510 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3511
3512 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3513
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003514
3515option log-separate-errors
3516no option log-separate-errors
3517 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 yes | yes | yes | no
3520 Arguments : none
3521
3522 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3523 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3524 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3525 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3526 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3527 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3528 provides very important information.
3529
3530 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3531 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3532 error logs.
3533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003534 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003535 logging.
3536
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003537
3538option logasap
3539no option logasap
3540 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3542 yes | yes | yes | no
3543 Arguments : none
3544
3545 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3546 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3547 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3548 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3549 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3550 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3551 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003552 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003553 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3554 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3555
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003556 Examples :
3557 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3558 mode http
3559 option httplog
3560 option logasap
3561 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3562
3563 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3564 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3565 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3566 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003568 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003569 logging.
3570
3571
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003572option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3573 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3575 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003576 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003577 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3578 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003579
3580 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3581 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3582 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3583 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3584 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3585 in the MySQL table, like this :
3586
3587 USE mysql;
3588 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3589 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3590
3591 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3592 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3593 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3594 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3595 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3596 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3597 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3598 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3599 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3600
3601 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3602 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003603
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003604 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003605
3606 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3607 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3608 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3609 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3610 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3611 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3612
3613 See also: "option httpchk"
3614
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003615option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3616 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | no | yes | yes
3619 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003620 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3621 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003622
3623 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3624 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3625 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3626 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3627
3628 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003629
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003630option nolinger
3631no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003632 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3634 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003635 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003636
3637 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3638 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3639 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3640 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3641 connections.
3642
3643 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3644 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3645 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3646 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3647 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3648 this too.
3649
3650 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3651 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3652 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3653
3654 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3655 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3656 for servers.
3657
3658 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3659 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3660
3661
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003662option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3663 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | yes | yes | yes
3666 Arguments :
3667 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3668 matching <network>
3669 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3670 header name.
3671
3672 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3673 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3674 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3675 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3676 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3677 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3678 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3679 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3680 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3681 possible that the client has already brought one.
3682
3683 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3684 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3685 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3686 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3687 header and requires different one.
3688
3689 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3690 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3691 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3692 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3693 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3694 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3695 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3696
3697 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3698 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3699 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3700 both are defined.
3701
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003702 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3703 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3704 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3705 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3706 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003707
3708 Examples :
3709 # Original Destination address
3710 frontend www
3711 mode http
3712 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3713
3714 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3715 backend www
3716 mode http
3717 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3718
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003719 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3720 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003721
3722
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003723option persist
3724no option persist
3725 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003728 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003729
3730 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3731 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3732 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3733 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3734 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3735 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3736 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3737 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3738 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3739 redirected to another valid server.
3740
3741 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3742 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3743
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003744 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003745
3746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003747option redispatch
3748no option redispatch
3749 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003752 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003753
3754 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3755 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3756 be able to access the service anymore.
3757
3758 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3759 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3760
3761 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3762 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3763 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003765 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3766 "redisp" keywords.
3767
3768 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3769 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3770
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003771 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003772
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003773
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003774option redis-check
3775 Use redis health checks for server testing
3776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | no | yes | yes
3778 Arguments : none
3779
3780 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3781 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3782 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3783 find the "+PONG" response message.
3784
3785 Example :
3786 option redis-check
3787
3788 See also : "option httpchk"
3789
3790
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003791option smtpchk
3792option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3793 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003796 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003797 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3798 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3799 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3800
3801 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3802 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3803 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3804
3805 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3806 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3807 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3808 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3809 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3810 dead server.
3811
3812 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3813 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3814 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3815 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3816
3817 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3818 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3819 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3820 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3821 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3822
3823 Example :
3824 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3825
3826 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3827
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003829option socket-stats
3830no option socket-stats
3831
3832 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3834 yes | yes | yes | no
3835
3836 Arguments : none
3837
3838
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003839option splice-auto
3840no option splice-auto
3841 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 yes | yes | yes | yes
3844 Arguments : none
3845
3846 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3847 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3848 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3849 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003850 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003851 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3852 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3853 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3854 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3855
3856 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3857 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3858 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3859 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3860 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3861 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3862 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3863 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3864 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3865 keyword.
3866
3867 Example :
3868 option splice-auto
3869
3870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3872
3873 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3874 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3875
3876
3877option splice-request
3878no option splice-request
3879 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3881 yes | yes | yes | yes
3882 Arguments : none
3883
3884 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003885 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003886 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3887 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3888 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3889 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3890
3891 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3892
3893 Example :
3894 option splice-request
3895
3896 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3897 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3898
3899 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3900 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3901
3902
3903option splice-response
3904no option splice-response
3905 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3907 yes | yes | yes | yes
3908 Arguments : none
3909
3910 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003911 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003912 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3913 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3914 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3915 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3916
3917 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3918
3919 Example :
3920 option splice-response
3921
3922 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3923 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3924
3925 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3926 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3927
3928
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003929option srvtcpka
3930no option srvtcpka
3931 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3933 yes | no | yes | yes
3934 Arguments : none
3935
3936 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3937 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3938 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3939 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3940
3941 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3942 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3943 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3944 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3945
3946 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3947 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3948 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3949 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3950 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3951
3952 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3953
3954 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3955 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3956 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3957
3958 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3959 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3960
3961 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3962
3963
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003964option ssl-hello-chk
3965 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3967 yes | no | yes | yes
3968 Arguments : none
3969
3970 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3971 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3972 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3973 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3974 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3975 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3976 hello message.
3977
3978 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3979 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3980 messages, which is appreciable.
3981
3982 See also: "option httpchk"
3983
3984
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003985option tcp-smart-accept
3986no option tcp-smart-accept
3987 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3989 yes | yes | yes | no
3990 Arguments : none
3991
3992 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3993 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3994 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3995 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3996 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3997 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3998
3999 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4000 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4001 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4002 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4003
4004 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4005 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4006 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4007 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4008
4009 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4010 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4011 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4012
4013 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4014 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4015 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4016
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004017 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4018
4019
4020option tcp-smart-connect
4021no option tcp-smart-connect
4022 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | no | yes | yes
4025 Arguments : none
4026
4027 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4028 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4029 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4030 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4031 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4032
4033 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4034 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4035 complex.
4036
4037 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4038 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4039 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4040
4041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4043
4044 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4045
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004046
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004047option tcpka
4048 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4050 yes | yes | yes | yes
4051 Arguments : none
4052
4053 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4054 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4055 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4056 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4057
4058 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4059 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4060 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4061 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4062
4063 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4064 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4065 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4066 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4067 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4068
4069 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4070
4071 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4072 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4073 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4074 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4075 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4076 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4077 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4078 backends.
4079
4080 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4081
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004082
4083option tcplog
4084 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4086 yes | yes | yes | yes
4087 Arguments : none
4088
4089 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4090 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4091 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4092 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4093 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4094 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4095 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4096 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4097
4098 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004100 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004101
4102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004103option transparent
4104no option transparent
4105 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004107 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004108 Arguments : none
4109
4110 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4111 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4112 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4113 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4114 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4115 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4116 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4117 appropriate server.
4118
4119 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4120 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4121
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004122 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004123 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004124
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004125
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004126persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004127persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004128 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4130 yes | no | yes | yes
4131 Arguments :
4132 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004133 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4134 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004135
4136 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4137 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4138 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4139 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4140 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4141 forwarded to this server.
4142
4143 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4144 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4145 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004146 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004147 a single "listen" section.
4148
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004149 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4150 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4151 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4152
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004153 Example :
4154 listen tse-farm
4155 bind :3389
4156 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4157 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4158 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4159 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4160 persist rdp-cookie
4161 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004162 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004163 balance rdp-cookie
4164 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4165 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4166
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004167 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4168 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004169
4170
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004171rate-limit sessions <rate>
4172 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4174 yes | yes | yes | no
4175 Arguments :
4176 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4177 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4178
4179 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4180 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4181 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4182 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4183 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4184 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4185
4186 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4187 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4188 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4189 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4190
4191 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4192 listen smtp
4193 mode tcp
4194 bind :25
4195 rate-limit sessions 10
4196 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4197
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004198 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4199 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4200 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004201
4202 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4203
4204
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004205redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4206redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4207redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004208 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4210 no | yes | yes | yes
4211
4212 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004213 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004214
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004215 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004216 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4217 the HTTP "Location" header.
4218
4219 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4220 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4221 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4222 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4223 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4224 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4225
4226 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4227 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4228 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4229 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4230 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4231 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4232 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4233 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4234 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004235
4236 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4237 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4238 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4239 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4240 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4241 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4242 location with a GET method.
4243
4244 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4245 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4246
4247 - "drop-query"
4248 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4249 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4250 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4251 with a location-type redirect.
4252
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004253 - "append-slash"
4254 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4255 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4256 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4257 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4258
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004259 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4260 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4261 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4262 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4263 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4264 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4265 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4266
4267 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4268 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4269 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4270 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4271 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4272 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4273 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004274
4275 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4276 acl clear dst_port 80
4277 acl secure dst_port 8080
4278 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004279 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004280 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004281 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4282
4283 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004284 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4285 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4286 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004287 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004288
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004289 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4290 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4291 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4292
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004293 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
4294 redirect scheme https if !{ is_ssl }
4295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004296 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004297
4298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004299redisp (deprecated)
4300redispatch (deprecated)
4301 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4302 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4303 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004304 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004305
4306 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4307 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4308 be able to access the service anymore.
4309
4310 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4311 redistribute them to a working server.
4312
4313 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4314 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4315 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004317 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4318 "option redispatch" instead.
4319
4320 See also : "option redispatch"
4321
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004322
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004323reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004324 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4326 no | yes | yes | yes
4327 Arguments :
4328 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4329 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004330 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004331
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004332 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4333 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4334
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004335 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4336 the last header of an HTTP request.
4337
4338 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4339 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4340 responses.
4341
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004342 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4343 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4344 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4345
4346 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4347 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004348
4349
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004350reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4351reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004352 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4354 no | yes | yes | yes
4355 Arguments :
4356 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4357 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4358 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4359 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4360 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4361 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4362 ignores case.
4363
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004364 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4365 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4366
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004367 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4368 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4369 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4370 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004371 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004372
4373 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4374 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4375
4376 Example :
4377 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4378 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4379 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4380
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004381 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4382 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004383
4384
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004385reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4386reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004387 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4389 no | yes | yes | yes
4390 Arguments :
4391 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4392 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4393 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4394 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4395 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4396 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4397
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004398 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4399 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4400
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004401 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4402 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4403 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4404 next servers.
4405
4406 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4407 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4408 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4409
4410 Example :
4411 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4412 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4413 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4414
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004415 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4416 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004417
4418
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004419reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4420reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004421 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4423 no | yes | yes | yes
4424 Arguments :
4425 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4426 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4427 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4428 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4429 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4430 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4431 case.
4432
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004433 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4434 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4435
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004436 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4437 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4438 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4439 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004440 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004441
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004442 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004443 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004444 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004445
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004446 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4447 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4448
4449 Example :
4450 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4451 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4452 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4453
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004454 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4455 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004456
4457
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004458reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4459reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004460 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4462 no | yes | yes | yes
4463 Arguments :
4464 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4465 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4466 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4467 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4468 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4469 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4470 case.
4471
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004472 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4473 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4474
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004475 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4476 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4477 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4478 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4479
4480 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4481 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4482
4483 Example :
4484 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4485 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4486 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4487 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4488
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004489 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4490 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004491
4492
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004493reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4494reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004495 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 no | yes | yes | yes
4498 Arguments :
4499 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4500 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4501 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4502 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4503 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4504 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4505
4506 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4507 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4508 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4509 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004510 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004512 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4513 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4514
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004515 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4516 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4517 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4518
4519 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4520 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4521 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4522 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4523 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4524
4525 Example :
4526 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004527 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004528 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4529 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4530
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004531 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4532 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004533
4534
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004535reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4536reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004537 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4539 no | yes | yes | yes
4540 Arguments :
4541 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4542 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4543 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4544 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4545 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4546 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4547 ignores case.
4548
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004549 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4550 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4551
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004552 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4553 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004554 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4555 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4556 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004557 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4558 not set.
4559
4560 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4561 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4562 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4563 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4564 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4565
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004566 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004567 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4568 # block all others.
4569 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4570 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4571
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004572 # block bad guys
4573 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4574 reqitarpit . if badguys
4575
4576 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4577 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004578
4579
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004580retries <value>
4581 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4583 yes | no | yes | yes
4584 Arguments :
4585 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4586 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4587 default value is 3.
4588
4589 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4590 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4591 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4592
4593 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4594 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4595
4596 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4597 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4598
4599 See also : "option redispatch"
4600
4601
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004602rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004603 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4605 no | yes | yes | yes
4606 Arguments :
4607 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4608 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004609 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004610
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004611 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4612 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4613
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004614 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4615 the last header of an HTTP response.
4616
4617 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4618 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4619 responses.
4620
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004621 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4622 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004623
4624
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004625rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4626rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004627 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4629 no | yes | yes | yes
4630 Arguments :
4631 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4632 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4633 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4634 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4635 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4636 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4637 ignores case.
4638
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004639 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4640 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4641
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004642 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4643 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004644 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004645 client.
4646
4647 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4648 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4649 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4650
4651 Example :
4652 # remove the Server header from responses
4653 reqidel ^Server:.*
4654
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004655 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4656 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004657
4658
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004659rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4660rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004661 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4663 no | yes | yes | yes
4664 Arguments :
4665 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4666 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4667 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4668 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4669 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4670 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4671 ignores case.
4672
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004673 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4674 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4675
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004676 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4677 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4678 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4679 case-sensitive.
4680
4681 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004682 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4683 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4684 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004685
4686 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4687 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4688
4689 Example :
4690 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4691 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4692
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004693 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4694 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004695
4696
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004697rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4698rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004699 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 no | yes | yes | yes
4702 Arguments :
4703 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4704 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4705 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4706 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4707 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4708 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4709 ignores case.
4710
4711 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4712 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4713 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4714 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004715 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004716
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004717 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4718 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4719
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004720 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4721 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4722 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4723
4724 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4725 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4726 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4727 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4728 are not case-sensitive.
4729
4730 Example :
4731 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4732 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4733
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004734 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4735 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004736
4737
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004738server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004739 Declare a server in a backend
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 no | no | yes | yes
4742 Arguments :
4743 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004744 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4745 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004746
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004747 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4748 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4749 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4750 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004751 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4752 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4753 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4754 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4755 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4756 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004757
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004758 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004759 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4760 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4761 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4762 adding this value to the client's port.
4763
4764 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4765 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004766 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004767
4768 Examples :
4769 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4770 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4771
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004772 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4773 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004774
4775
4776source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004777source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004778source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004779 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | no | yes | yes
4782 Arguments :
4783 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4784 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4785 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4786 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4787
4788 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4789 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004790 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4791 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4792 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004793
4794 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4795 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4796 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4797 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4798 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4799 <addr>.
4800
4801 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4802 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4803 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4804 port.
4805
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004806 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4807 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4808 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4809 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4810 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4811 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4812 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4813 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4814 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4815 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4816 HTTP header.
4817
4818 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4819 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004820 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004821 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4822 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4823 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4824 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4825 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4826 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4827 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4828
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004829 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4830 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4831 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4832 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4833 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4834 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4835
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004836 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4837 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4838 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4839 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4840
4841 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4842 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4843 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4844 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4845 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4846 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4847
4848 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4849 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4850 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4851 there are two methods :
4852
4853 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4854 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4855 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4856 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4857 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4858 of the client ranges may be used.
4859
4860 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4861 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4862 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4863 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4864 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4865 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4866 same session.
4867
4868 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4869 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4870 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4871 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4872 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4873 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4874
4875 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4876 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4877 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004878 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004879
4880 Examples :
4881 backend private
4882 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4883 source 192.168.1.200
4884
4885 backend transparent_ssl1
4886 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4887 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4888
4889 backend transparent_ssl2
4890 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4891 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4892 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4893
4894 backend transparent_ssl3
4895 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4896 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4897 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4898
4899 backend transparent_smtp
4900 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4901 # with Tproxy version 4.
4902 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4903
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004904 backend transparent_http
4905 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4906 # proxy.
4907 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004909 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004910 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004912
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004913srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4914 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4916 yes | no | yes | yes
4917 Arguments :
4918 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4920 as explained at the top of this document.
4921
4922 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4923 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4924 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4925 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4926 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4927 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4928 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4929
4930 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4931 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4932 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4933 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4934 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004935 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004936 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004937 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004938
4939 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4940 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4941 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4942 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4943 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4944 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4945
4946 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4947 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4948
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004949 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
4950 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004951
4952
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004953stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4954 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4956 no | no | yes | yes
4957
4958 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4959 matched.
4960
4961 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4962 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4963
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004964 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4965 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4966 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4967
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004968 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4969 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4970 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4971 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004972
4973 Example :
4974 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4975 backend stats_localhost
4976 stats enable
4977 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4978
4979 Example :
4980 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4981 backend stats_auth
4982 stats enable
4983 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4984 stats admin if TRUE
4985
4986 Example :
4987 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4988 userlist stats-auth
4989 group admin users admin
4990 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4991 group readonly users haproxy
4992 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4993
4994 backend stats_auth
4995 stats enable
4996 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4997 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4998 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4999 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5000
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005001 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5002 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5003 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005004
5005
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005006stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5007 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5009 yes | no | yes | yes
5010 Arguments :
5011 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5012
5013 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5014
5015 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5016 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5017 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5018 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5019 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5020 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5021
5022 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5023 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5024 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005025 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005026
5027 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5028 report using "stats scope".
5029
5030 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5031 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5032 unobvious parameters.
5033
5034 Example :
5035 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5036 backend public_www
5037 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5038 stats enable
5039 stats hide-version
5040 stats scope .
5041 stats uri /admin?stats
5042 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5043 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5044 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5045
5046 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5047 backend private_monitoring
5048 stats enable
5049 stats uri /admin?stats
5050 stats refresh 5s
5051
5052 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5053
5054
5055stats enable
5056 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5058 yes | no | yes | yes
5059 Arguments : none
5060
5061 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5062 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5063 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5064 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5065 - stats auth : no authentication
5066 - stats scope : no restriction
5067
5068 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5069 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5070 unobvious parameters.
5071
5072 Example :
5073 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5074 backend public_www
5075 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5076 stats enable
5077 stats hide-version
5078 stats scope .
5079 stats uri /admin?stats
5080 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5081 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5082 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5083
5084 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5085 backend private_monitoring
5086 stats enable
5087 stats uri /admin?stats
5088 stats refresh 5s
5089
5090 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5091
5092
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005093stats hide-version
5094 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005097 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005098
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005099 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5100 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5101 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5102 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5103 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5104 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005106 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5107 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5108 unobvious parameters.
5109
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005110 Example :
5111 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5112 backend public_www
5113 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005114 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005115 stats hide-version
5116 stats scope .
5117 stats uri /admin?stats
5118 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5119 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5120 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005121
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005122 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5123 backend private_monitoring
5124 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005125 stats uri /admin?stats
5126 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005127
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005128 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005129
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005130
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005131stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5132 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5133 Access control for statistics
5134
5135 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 no | no | yes | yes
5137
5138 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5139 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5140 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5141 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5142 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5143 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5144
5145 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5146 instance.
5147
5148 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5149 about ACL usage.
5150
5151
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005152stats realm <realm>
5153 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5155 yes | no | yes | yes
5156 Arguments :
5157 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5158 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5159 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5160
5161 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5162 using a backslash ('\').
5163
5164 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5165 only related to authentication.
5166
5167 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5168 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5169 unobvious parameters.
5170
5171 Example :
5172 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5173 backend public_www
5174 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5175 stats enable
5176 stats hide-version
5177 stats scope .
5178 stats uri /admin?stats
5179 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5180 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5181 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5182
5183 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5184 backend private_monitoring
5185 stats enable
5186 stats uri /admin?stats
5187 stats refresh 5s
5188
5189 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5190
5191
5192stats refresh <delay>
5193 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | no | yes | yes
5196 Arguments :
5197 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5198 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5199 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5200 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5201 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5202 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5203
5204 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5205 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5206 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5207 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5208
5209 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5210 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5211 unobvious parameters.
5212
5213 Example :
5214 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5215 backend public_www
5216 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5217 stats enable
5218 stats hide-version
5219 stats scope .
5220 stats uri /admin?stats
5221 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5222 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5223 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5224
5225 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5226 backend private_monitoring
5227 stats enable
5228 stats uri /admin?stats
5229 stats refresh 5s
5230
5231 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5232
5233
5234stats scope { <name> | "." }
5235 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5237 yes | no | yes | yes
5238 Arguments :
5239 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5240 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5241 section in which the statement appears.
5242
5243 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5244 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5245 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5246 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5247 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5248 exists.
5249
5250 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5251 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5252 unobvious parameters.
5253
5254 Example :
5255 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5256 backend public_www
5257 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5258 stats enable
5259 stats hide-version
5260 stats scope .
5261 stats uri /admin?stats
5262 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5263 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5264 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5265
5266 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5267 backend private_monitoring
5268 stats enable
5269 stats uri /admin?stats
5270 stats refresh 5s
5271
5272 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5273
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005274
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005275stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005276 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | no | yes | yes
5279
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005280 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005281 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5282
5283 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5284 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5285
5286 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5287 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005288 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005289
5290 Example :
5291 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5292 backend private_monitoring
5293 stats enable
5294 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5295 stats uri /admin?stats
5296 stats refresh 5s
5297
5298 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5299 global section.
5300
5301
5302stats show-legends
5303 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5304 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5305 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5306 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5307 - IP (socket, server)
5308 - cookie (backend, server)
5309
5310 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5311 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005312 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005313
5314 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5315
5316
5317stats show-node [ <name> ]
5318 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 yes | no | yes | yes
5321 Arguments:
5322 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5323 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5324
5325 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5326 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005327 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005328
5329 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5330 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5331 unobvious parameters.
5332
5333 Example:
5334 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5335 backend private_monitoring
5336 stats enable
5337 stats show-node Europe-1
5338 stats uri /admin?stats
5339 stats refresh 5s
5340
5341 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5342 section.
5343
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005344
5345stats uri <prefix>
5346 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5348 yes | no | yes | yes
5349 Arguments :
5350 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5351 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5352 query string.
5353
5354 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5355 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5356 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5357 possible to reach it in the application.
5358
5359 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005360 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005361 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5362 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5363 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5364 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5365
5366 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5367 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5368 an address or a port to statistics only.
5369
5370 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5371 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5372 unobvious parameters.
5373
5374 Example :
5375 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5376 backend public_www
5377 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5378 stats enable
5379 stats hide-version
5380 stats scope .
5381 stats uri /admin?stats
5382 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5383 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5384 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5385
5386 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5387 backend private_monitoring
5388 stats enable
5389 stats uri /admin?stats
5390 stats refresh 5s
5391
5392 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5393
5394
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005395stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5396 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005398 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005399
5400 Arguments :
5401 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5402 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5403 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5404 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5405
5406 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5407 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5408 the "stick-table" statement.
5409
5410 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5411 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5412 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5413 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5414 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5415
5416 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5417 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5418 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5419 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5420 transformation rules.
5421
5422 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5423 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5424 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5425 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5426 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5427 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5428 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5429
5430 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5431 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5432 ACL based conditions.
5433
5434 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5435 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5436 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5437 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5438
5439 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5440 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5441 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5442 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5443
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005444 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5445 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5446 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5447
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005448 Example :
5449 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5450 # last 30 minutes
5451 backend pop
5452 mode tcp
5453 balance roundrobin
5454 stick store-request src
5455 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5456 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5457 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5458
5459 backend smtp
5460 mode tcp
5461 balance roundrobin
5462 stick match src table pop
5463 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5464 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5465
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005466 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5467 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005468
5469
5470stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5471 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5473 no | no | yes | yes
5474
5475 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5476 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5477 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5478 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5479
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005480 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5481 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5482 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5483
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005484 Examples :
5485 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005486 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005487
5488 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5489 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5490 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5491
5492
5493 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5494 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5495 backend http
5496 mode http
5497 balance roundrobin
5498 stick on src table https
5499 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5500 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5501 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5502
5503 backend https
5504 mode tcp
5505 balance roundrobin
5506 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5507 stick on src
5508 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5509 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5510
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005511 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005512
5513
5514stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5515 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5517 no | no | yes | yes
5518
5519 Arguments :
5520 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5521 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5522 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5523 server is selected.
5524
5525 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5526 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5527 the "stick-table" statement.
5528
5529 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5530 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5531 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5532 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5533 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5534 address.
5535
5536 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5537 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5538 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5539 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5540 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5541 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5542 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5543 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5544 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5545 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5546
5547 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5548 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5549 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5550 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5551 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5552 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5553 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5554
5555 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5556 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5557 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5558 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5559
5560 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5561 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5562 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5563 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5564 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5565 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5566 another protocol or access method.
5567
5568 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5569 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5570 the request.
5571
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005572 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5573 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5574 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5575
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005576 Example :
5577 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5578 # last 30 minutes
5579 backend pop
5580 mode tcp
5581 balance roundrobin
5582 stick store-request src
5583 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5584 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5585 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5586
5587 backend smtp
5588 mode tcp
5589 balance roundrobin
5590 stick match src table pop
5591 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5592 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5593
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005594 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5595 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005596
5597
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005598stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005599 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5600 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005601 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005603 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005604
5605 Arguments :
5606 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5607 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5608 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5609 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5610
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005611 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5612 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5613 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5614 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5615
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005616 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5617 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5618 instance.
5619
5620 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5621 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5622 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5623 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5624 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5625 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005626 to 32 characters.
5627
5628 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5629 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5630 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5631 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5632 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5633 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005634
5635 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005636 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5637 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005638 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5639 increase.
5640
5641 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005642 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5643 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5644 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005645
5646 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5647 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5648 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5649 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5650 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5651 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5652 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5653 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5654 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5655 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5656 parameter (see below).
5657
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005658 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5659 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5660 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5661 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5662 soft restart.
5663
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005664 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5665
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005666 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5667 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5668 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5669 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5670 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005671 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005672 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5673 if not expiration delay is specified.
5674
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005675 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5676 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5677 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5678 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005679 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5680 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5681 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5682 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5683 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5684 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5685 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5686 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5687 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5688 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5689 types and their arguments.
5690
5691 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5692 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5693 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5694 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5695
5696 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5697 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5698 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5699 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5700
5701 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5702 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5703 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5704 they were received.
5705
5706 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5707 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5708 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5709 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5710 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5711
5712 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5713 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5714 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5715 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5716 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5717
5718 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5719 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5720 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5721
5722 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5723 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5724 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5725 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5726 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5727
5728 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5729 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5730 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5731 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5732 the client side.
5733
5734 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5735 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5736 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5737 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5738 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5739 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5740 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5741
5742 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5743 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5744 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5745 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5746 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5747 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5748 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5749
5750 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5751 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5752 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5753 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5754 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5755 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5756
5757 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5758 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5759 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5760 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5761
5762 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5763 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5764 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5765 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5766 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5767 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5768 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5769 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5770 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5771 recommended for better fairness.
5772
5773 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5774 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5775 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5776 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5777
5778 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5779 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5780 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5781 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5782 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5783 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5784 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5785 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5786 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5787 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005788
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005789 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5790 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005791 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5792 reference it.
5793
5794 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5795 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5796 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5797 as an exclusive stickiness.
5798
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005799 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5800 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5801 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5802 something that can be ignored.
5803
5804 Example:
5805 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5806 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5807 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5808 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5809
5810 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005811 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005812
5813
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005814stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5815 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5817 no | no | yes | yes
5818
5819 Arguments :
5820 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5821 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5822 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5823 server is selected.
5824
5825 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5826 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5827 the "stick-table" statement.
5828
5829 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5830 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5831 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5832 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5833
5834 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5835 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5836 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5837 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5838 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5839 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005840 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005841 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5842 rules.
5843
5844 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5845 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5846 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5847 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5848 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5849 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5850 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5851
5852 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5853 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5854 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5855 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5856
5857 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5858 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5859 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5860 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5861 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5862 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5863 another protocol or access method.
5864
5865 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5866
5867 Example :
5868 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5869 backend https
5870 mode tcp
5871 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005872 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005873 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005874
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005875 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5876 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5877
5878 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5879 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5880 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5881
5882 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5883 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005884
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005885 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5886 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5887 # at offset 44.
5888
5889 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5890 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5891
5892 # Learn on response if server hello.
5893 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005894
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005895 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5896 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5897
5898 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5899 extraction.
5900
5901
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005902tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5903 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5905 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005906 Arguments :
5907 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5908 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5909 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005910
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005911 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005912
5913 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5914 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005915 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5916 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5917 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5918 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5919 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5920 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005921
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005922 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5923 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5924 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5925 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005927 Three types of actions are supported :
5928 - accept :
5929 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5930 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5931 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005932
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005933 - reject :
5934 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5935 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5936 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5937 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5938 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5939 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5940 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5941 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5942 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5943 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5944 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5945 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005946
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005947 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5948 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5949 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5950 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5951 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5952 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5953 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5954 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5955 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005956
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005957 These actions take one or two arguments :
5958 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5959 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5960 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005961
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005962 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5963 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5964 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5965 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005966
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005967 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5968 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5969 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5970 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5971 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5972 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5973 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5974 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5975 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5976 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005977
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005978 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5979 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5980 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005982 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5983 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5984 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005985
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005986 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005987 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005988 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005989
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005990 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5991 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5992 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005994 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5995 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5996 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005997
5998 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5999
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006000 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006001
6002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006003tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6004 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006006 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006007 Arguments :
6008 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6009 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6010 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006011
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006012 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006013
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006014 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6015 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6016 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6017 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6018 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006020 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6021 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6022 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6023 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6024 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6025 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6026 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6027 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6028 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006030 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6031 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6032 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6033 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006035 Three types of actions are supported :
6036 - accept :
6037 - reject :
6038 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006040 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6041 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006042
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006043 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6044 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6045 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6046 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6047 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6048 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006050 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006051 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6052 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006054 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006055 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6056 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6057 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6058 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6059 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006060
6061 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006062 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6063 # and reject everything else.
6064 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6065 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006066 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006067 tcp-request content reject
6068
6069 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006070 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6071 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6072 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006073 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006074
6075 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6076 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6077 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006078 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006079 tcp-request content reject
6080
6081 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6082 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6083
6084 frontend http
6085 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6086 # protecting all our sites
6087 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6088 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6089 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6090 ...
6091 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6092
6093 backend http_dynamic
6094 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6095 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6096 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6097 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6098 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6099 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6100 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006102 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006104 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006105
6106
6107tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6108 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006110 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006111 Arguments :
6112 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6113 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6114 as explained at the top of this document.
6115
6116 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6117 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6118 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6119 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6120 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6121
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006122 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6123 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6124 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6125 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6126
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006127 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6128 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006129 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006130 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006131 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6132 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6133 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6134 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006135
6136 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6137 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6138 it pass through unaffected.
6139
6140 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6141 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6142 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006143 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006144 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6145 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006146 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6147 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6148 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006149
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006150 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006151 "timeout client".
6152
6153
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006154tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6155 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6157 no | no | yes | yes
6158 Arguments :
6159 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6160 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6161 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6162
6163 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6164
6165 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6166 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6167 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6168 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006169 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006170
6171 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6172
6173 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6174 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6175 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6176 inserted.
6177
6178 Two types of actions are supported :
6179 - accept :
6180 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6181 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6182 the rules evaluation.
6183
6184 - reject :
6185 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6186 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006187 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006188
6189 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6190 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6191 for changing the default action to a reject.
6192
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006193 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6194 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6195 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6196 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006197 period.
6198
6199 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6200
6201 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6202
6203
6204tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6205 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6207 no | no | yes | yes
6208 Arguments :
6209 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6211 as explained at the top of this document.
6212
6213 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6214
6215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006216timeout check <timeout>
6217 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6218 established.
6219
6220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6221 yes | no | yes | yes
6222 Arguments:
6223 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6224 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6225 as explained at the top of this document.
6226
6227 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6228 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6229 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6230 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006231 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6232 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6233 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006234
6235 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6236 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6237
6238 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6239 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006240 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006241
6242 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6243 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6244 forget about it.
6245
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006246 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6247 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006248
6249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006250timeout client <timeout>
6251timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6252 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6254 yes | yes | yes | no
6255 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006256 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006257 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6258 as explained at the top of this document.
6259
6260 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6261 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6262 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6263 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6264 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6265 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6266 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6267 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006268 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006269 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006270 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6271 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6272 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006273
6274 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6275 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6276 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6277 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6278 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6279 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6280
6281 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6282 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6283 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6284
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006285 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006286
6287
6288timeout connect <timeout>
6289timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6290 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6292 yes | no | yes | yes
6293 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006294 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006295 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6296 as explained at the top of this document.
6297
6298 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006299 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006300 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006301 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006302 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6303 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006304
6305 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6306 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6307 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6308 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6309 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6310 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6311
6312 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6313 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6314 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6315
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006316 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6317 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006318
6319
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006320timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6321 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6323 yes | yes | yes | yes
6324 Arguments :
6325 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6326 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6327 as explained at the top of this document.
6328
6329 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6330 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6331 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6332 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6333 once the request has started to present itself.
6334
6335 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6336 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6337 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6338 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6339 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6340
6341 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6342 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6343 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6344 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6345
6346 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6347 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6348 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6349 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6350 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006351 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006352
6353 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6354 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6355 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6356 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6357
6358 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6359
6360
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006361timeout http-request <timeout>
6362 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006364 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006365 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006366 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006367 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6368 as explained at the top of this document.
6369
6370 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6371 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6372 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6373 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6374 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6375 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6376 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6377 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6378
6379 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6380 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006381 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6382 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006383
6384 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6385 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6386 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6387 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6388 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6389
6390 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006391 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6392 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6393 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006394
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006395 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006396
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006397
6398timeout queue <timeout>
6399 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6401 yes | no | yes | yes
6402 Arguments :
6403 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6405 as explained at the top of this document.
6406
6407 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6408 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6409 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6410 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6411 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6412
6413 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6414 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6415 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6416 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6417
6418 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6419
6420
6421timeout server <timeout>
6422timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6423 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 yes | no | yes | yes
6426 Arguments :
6427 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6428 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6429 as explained at the top of this document.
6430
6431 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6432 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6433 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6434 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6435 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6436 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6437 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6438
6439 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6440 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6441 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6442 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6443 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006444 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006445 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006446 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6447 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6448 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6449 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006450
6451 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6452 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6453 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6454 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6455 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6456 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6457
6458 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6459 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6460 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6461
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006462 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006463
6464
6465timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006466 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6468 yes | yes | yes | yes
6469 Arguments :
6470 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6471 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6472 as explained at the top of this document.
6473
6474 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6475 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6476 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6477
6478 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6479 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6480 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6481 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006482 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006483
6484 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6485
6486
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006487timeout tunnel <timeout>
6488 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6490 yes | no | yes | yes
6491 Arguments :
6492 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6493 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6494 as explained at the top of this document.
6495
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006496 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006497 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6498 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6499 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6500 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6501 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6502 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6503 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6504 specified.
6505
6506 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6507 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6508 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6509 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6510 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6511
6512 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6513 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6514 forget about it.
6515
6516 Example :
6517 defaults http
6518 option http-server-close
6519 timeout connect 5s
6520 timeout client 30s
6521 timeout client 30s
6522 timeout server 30s
6523 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6524
6525 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6526
6527
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006528transparent (deprecated)
6529 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006531 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006532 Arguments : none
6533
6534 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6535 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6536 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6537 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6538 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6539 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6540 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6541 appropriate server.
6542
6543 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6544
6545 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6546 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6547
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006548 See also: "option transparent"
6549
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006550unique-id-format <string>
6551 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6553 yes | yes | yes | no
6554 Arguments :
6555 <string> is a log-format string.
6556
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006557 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6558 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6559 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6560 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006561
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006562 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6563 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6564 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6565 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6566 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6567 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6568 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6569 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006570
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006571 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6572 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006573
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006574 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006575
6576 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6577
6578 will generate:
6579
6580 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6581
6582 See also: "unique-id-header"
6583
6584unique-id-header <name>
6585 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | yes | yes | no
6588 Arguments :
6589 <name> is the name of the header.
6590
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006591 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6592 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006593
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006594 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006595
6596 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6597 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6598
6599 will generate:
6600
6601 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6602
6603 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006604
6605use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6606use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006607 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6609 no | yes | yes | no
6610 Arguments :
6611 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006613 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006614
6615 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6616 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6617 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006618 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6619 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6620 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6621 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006622
6623 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6624 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6625 assign the backend.
6626
6627 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6628 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6629 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6630 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6631 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6632 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6633
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006634 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006635 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006636 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6637 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6638 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6639
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006640 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006641
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006642
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006643use-server <server> if <condition>
6644use-server <server> unless <condition>
6645 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6647 no | no | yes | yes
6648 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006649 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006650
6651 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6652
6653 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6654 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6655 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6656
6657 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6658 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6659 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6660 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6661 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6662 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6663 matches will assign the server.
6664
6665 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6666 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6667 with the next rules until one matches.
6668
6669 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6670 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6671 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6672 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6673
6674 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6675 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6676 stripped.
6677
6678 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6679 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6680 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6681 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6682
6683 Example :
6684 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6685 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6686 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6687 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6688 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6689 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6690 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6691 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6692 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6693
6694 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6695
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006696
66975. Bind and Server options
6698--------------------------
6699
6700The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6701depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6702settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6703written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6704described in this section.
6705
6706
67075.1. Bind options
6708-----------------
6709
6710The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6711as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6712no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6713parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6714while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6715provided immediately after the setting name.
6716
6717The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6718
6719accept-proxy
6720 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6721 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6722 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6723 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6724 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6725 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6726 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6727 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6728 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6729 usable.
6730
6731backlog <backlog>
6732 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6733 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6734
6735ciphers <ciphers>
6736 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6737 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6738 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6739 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6740 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6741
6742crt <cert>
6743 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6744 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6745 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
6746 files into one. If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all
6747 files found in that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified
6748 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
6749 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
6750 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
6751 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
6752 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
6753 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
6754 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the
6755 client provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first
6756 loaded certificate will be presented. This means that when loading
6757 certificates from a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default
6758 one first as a file. Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times
6759 without side effects.
6760
6761defer-accept
6762 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6763 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6764 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6765 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6766 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6767 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6768 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6769 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6770 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6771 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6772 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6773
6774gid <gid>
6775 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6776 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6777 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6778 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6779 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6780
6781group <group>
6782 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6783 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6784 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6785 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6786 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6787
6788id <id>
6789 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6790 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6791 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6792 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6793
6794interface <interface>
6795 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6796 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6797 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6798 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6799 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6800 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6801 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6802 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6803
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006804level <level>
6805 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6806 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6807 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6808 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6809 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6810 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6811 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6812 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6813 counters).
6814 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6815 all counters).
6816
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006817maxconn <maxconn>
6818 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6819 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6820 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6821 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6822 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6823 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6824 eat all memory.
6825
6826mode <mode>
6827 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6828 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6829 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6830 UNIX sockets.
6831
6832mss <maxseg>
6833 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6834 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6835 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6836 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6837 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6838 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6839 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6840 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6841 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6842 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6843 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6844
6845name <name>
6846 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
6847 page.
6848
6849nice <nice>
6850 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
6851 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
6852 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
6853 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
6854 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
6855 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
6856 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
6857 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
6858 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
6859 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
6860 one for an RDP socket.
6861
6862nosslv3
6863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6864 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6865 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
6866 be enabled using any configuration option.
6867
6868notlsv1
6869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6870 disables support for TLSv1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6871 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
6872 be enabled using any configuration option.
6873
6874prefer-server-ciphers
6875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6876 tells the SSL/TLS layer that our set of cipher algorithms is preferred over
6877 the client's ones.
6878
6879ssl
6880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6881 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
6882 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
6883 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
6884 to deciphered contents.
6885
6886transparent
6887 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6888 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
6889 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
6890 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
6891 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
6892 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
6893 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
6894 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
6895 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
6896 so check for support with your vendor.
6897
6898uid <uid>
6899 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
6900 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6901 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
6902 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
6903 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6904
6905user <user>
6906 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
6907 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6908 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
6909 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
6910 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6911
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006912
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020069135.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006914------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006916The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6917which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6918arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6919settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6920after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6921Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6922address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006924 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006925 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006927The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006928
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006929addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006930 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6931 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6932 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6933 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6934 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006936 Supported in default-server: No
6937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006938backup
6939 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6940 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6941 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6942 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6943 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6944 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006946 Supported in default-server: No
6947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006948check
6949 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006950 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6951 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6952 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6953 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6954 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6955 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6956 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6957 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6958 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6959 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006961 Supported in default-server: No
6962
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02006963ciphers <ciphers>
6964 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
6965 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
6966 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
6967 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
6968 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
6969 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
6970 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
6971 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
6972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973cookie <value>
6974 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6975 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6976 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6977 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6978 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6979 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6980 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006982 Supported in default-server: No
6983
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006984disabled
6985 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6986 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6987 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6988 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6989 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6990
6991 Supported in default-server: No
6992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006993error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006994 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6995 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6996 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006997
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006998 Supported in default-server: Yes
6999
7000 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007002fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007003 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7004 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7005 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007007 Supported in default-server: Yes
7008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007009id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007010 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7011 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7012 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007014 Supported in default-server: No
7015
7016inter <delay>
7017fastinter <delay>
7018downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007019 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7020 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7021 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7022 between checks depending on the server state :
7023
7024 Server state | Interval used
7025 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7026 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7027 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7028 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7029 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7030 or yet unchecked. |
7031 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7032 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7033 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007035 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7036 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7037 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7038 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7039 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7040 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7041 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7042 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7043 servers.
7044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007045 Supported in default-server: Yes
7046
7047maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007048 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7049 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7050 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7051 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7052 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7053 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7054 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7055 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007057 Supported in default-server: Yes
7058
7059maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007060 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7061 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7062 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7063 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7064 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7065 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7066 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007068 Supported in default-server: Yes
7069
7070minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007071 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7072 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7073 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7074 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7075 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7076 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007077 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007078 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007080 Supported in default-server: Yes
7081
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007082nosslv3
7083 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7084 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7085 using any configuration option.
7086
7087notlsv1
7088 This option disables support for TLSv1 when SSL is used to communicate with
7089 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7090 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
7091 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers.
7092
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007093non-stick
7094 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7095 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7096 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007098observe <mode>
7099 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7100 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7101 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7102 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7103 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7104 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007105 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007107 Supported in default-server: No
7108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007109 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007111on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007112 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7113 Currently, four modes are available:
7114 - fastinter: force fastinter
7115 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7116 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7117 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7118 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007120 Supported in default-server: Yes
7121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007122 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7123
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007124on-marked-down <action>
7125 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7126 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007127 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7128 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7129 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7130 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7131 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7132 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7133 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7134 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007135
7136 Actions are disabled by default
7137
7138 Supported in default-server: Yes
7139
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007140on-marked-up <action>
7141 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7142 Currently one action is available:
7143 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7144 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7145 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7146 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7147 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7148 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7149 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7150 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7151
7152 Actions are disabled by default
7153
7154 Supported in default-server: Yes
7155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007156port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007157 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7158 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7159 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7160 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7161 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7162 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007164 Supported in default-server: Yes
7165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007166redir <prefix>
7167 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7168 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7169 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7170 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7171 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7172 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7173 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7174 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007175 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007176 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7177 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7178 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7179 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7180 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7181
7182 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007184 Supported in default-server: No
7185
7186rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007187 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7188 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7189 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7190
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007191 Supported in default-server: Yes
7192
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007193send-proxy
7194 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7195 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7196 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7197 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7198 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7199 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7200 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7201 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7202 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7203 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7204 option of the "bind" keyword.
7205
7206 Supported in default-server: No
7207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007208slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007209 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7210 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7211 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7212 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7213 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7214 parameters :
7215
7216 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7217 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7218
7219 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7220 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7221 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7222 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7223
7224 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7225 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7226 seen as failed.
7227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007228 Supported in default-server: Yes
7229
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007230source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007231source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007232source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007233 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7234 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7235 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7236 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7237
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007238 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7239 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7240 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7241 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7242 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7243 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7244 server.
7245
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007246 Supported in default-server: No
7247
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007248ssl
7249 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7250 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7251 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7252 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7253 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications.
7254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007255track [<proxy>/]<server>
7256 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7257 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7258 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7259 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7260 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7261
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007262 Supported in default-server: No
7263
7264weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007265 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7266 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7267 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007268 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7269 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7270 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7271 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7272 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7273 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007274
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007275 Supported in default-server: Yes
7276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007277
72786. HTTP header manipulation
7279---------------------------
7280
7281In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7282response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7283request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7284which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7285against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7286to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7287passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7288headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7289never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7290
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007291There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7292(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7293rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7294messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7295in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007296happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007297add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7298normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007300This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7301in section 4.2 :
7302
7303 - reqadd <string>
7304 - reqallow <search>
7305 - reqiallow <search>
7306 - reqdel <search>
7307 - reqidel <search>
7308 - reqdeny <search>
7309 - reqideny <search>
7310 - reqpass <search>
7311 - reqipass <search>
7312 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7313 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7314 - reqtarpit <search>
7315 - reqitarpit <search>
7316 - rspadd <string>
7317 - rspdel <search>
7318 - rspidel <search>
7319 - rspdeny <search>
7320 - rspideny <search>
7321 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7322 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7323
7324With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7325is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7326parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7327prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7328Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7329
7330 \t for a tab
7331 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7332 \n for a new line (LF)
7333 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7334 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7335 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7336 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7337 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7338
7339The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7340portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7341above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7342regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
73439 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7344is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7345
7346The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7347after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7348
7349Notes related to these keywords :
7350---------------------------------
7351 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7352 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7353 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7354
7355 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7356 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7357 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7358
7359 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7360 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7361 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7362 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7363 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7364
7365 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7366 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7367 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7368 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7369 useless headers before adding new ones.
7370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007371 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007372 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7373
7374 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7375 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7376 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7377
7378 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7379 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007380 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007381
7382
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010073837. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7384------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007385
7386The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7387content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7388from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7389simple :
7390
7391 - define test criteria with sets of values
7392 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7393
7394The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7395
7396In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7397
7398 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7399
7400This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7401Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7402and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7403an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7404of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7405
7406ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7407'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7408which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7409
7410There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7411performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7412
7413The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7414
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007415 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7416 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007417 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7418
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007419The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7420specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7421possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007422multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7423be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7424needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7425space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7426match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7427lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7428duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007429to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007430instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007431
7432 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7433
7434In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7435the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7436case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7437too.
7438
7439Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7440a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7441ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7442
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007443Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007444
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007445 - integers or integer ranges
7446 - strings
7447 - regular expressions
7448 - IP addresses and networks
7449
7450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074517.1. Matching integers
7452----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007453
7454Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7455that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7456expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7457may be omitted.
7458
7459For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7460unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7461representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7462
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007463As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7464two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7465instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7466ranges and operators.
7467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007468For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007469operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7470Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7471of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007472
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007473Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007474
7475 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7476 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7477 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7478 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7479 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7480
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007481For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007482
7483 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7484
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007485This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7486
7487 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074907.2. Matching strings
7491---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007492
7493String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7494exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7495characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7496string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7497to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007498before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007499
7500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075017.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7502-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007503
7504Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7505they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7506possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7507passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7508the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007509the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7510match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007511
7512
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020075137.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007514----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007515
7516IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7517netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7518within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007519host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007520difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7521at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7522does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7523parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007524
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007525IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7526Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7527trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7528IPv6 patterns.
7529
7530HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7531following situations :
7532 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7533 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7534 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7535 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7536 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7537 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7538 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7539 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7540 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7541 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7542
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075447.5. Available matching criteria
7545--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075477.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7548------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007549
7550A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7551analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007552addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007554always_false
7555 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7556 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7557
7558always_true
7559 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7560 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7561
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007562avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007563avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007564 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7565 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7566 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7567 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7568 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7569 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7570 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7571 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7572 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7573 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7574 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007575
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007576be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007577be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007578 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7579 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7580 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7581 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7582 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007583
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007584be_id <integer>
7585 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7586 backend it was called.
7587
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007588be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007589be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007590 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7591 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7592 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7593 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7594 sucking of an online dictionary).
7595
7596 Example :
7597 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7598 backend dynamic
7599 mode http
7600 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7601 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007602
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007603connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007604connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007605 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007606 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007607 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7608
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007609 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7610 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007611
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007612 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007613 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7614 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7615 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7616 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7617 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007618 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007619
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007620 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7621 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7622 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7623 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007624
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007625dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007626 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7627 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007628
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007629dst_conn <integer>
7630 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7631 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7632 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7633 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7634 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7635 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7636
7637dst_port <integer>
7638 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7639 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7640
7641fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007642fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007643 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7644 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7645 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7646 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7647 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7648 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7649 criteria.
7650
7651fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007652 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007653 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007654
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007655fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007656fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007657 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7658 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7659 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7660 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7661 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7662 the rate to go down below the limit.
7663
7664 Example :
7665 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7666 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7667 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7668 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7669 frontend mail
7670 bind :25
7671 mode tcp
7672 maxconn 100
7673 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7674 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7675 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7676 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007677
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007678nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007679nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007680 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7681 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7682 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7683 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7684 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007685
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007686queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007687queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007688 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7689 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7690 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7691 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7692 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7693 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7694 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7695
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007696sc1_bytes_in_rate
7697sc2_bytes_in_rate
7698 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7699 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7700 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7701
7702sc1_bytes_out_rate
7703sc2_bytes_out_rate
7704 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7705 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7706 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7707
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007708sc1_clr_gpc0
7709sc2_clr_gpc0
7710 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7711 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7712 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7713 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7714 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7715 was verified :
7716
7717 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7718 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7719 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7720 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7721 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7722 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7723 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7724
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007725sc1_conn_cnt
7726sc2_conn_cnt
7727 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7728 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7729
7730sc1_conn_cur
7731sc2_conn_cur
7732 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7733 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7734 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7735
7736sc1_conn_rate
7737sc2_conn_rate
7738 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7739 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7740 See also src_conn_rate.
7741
7742sc1_get_gpc0
7743sc2_get_gpc0
7744 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7745 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7746
7747sc1_http_err_cnt
7748sc2_http_err_cnt
7749 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7750 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7751 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7752
7753sc1_http_err_rate
7754sc2_http_err_rate
7755 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7756 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7757 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7758 src_http_err_rate.
7759
7760sc1_http_req_cnt
7761sc2_http_req_cnt
7762 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7763 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7764 src_http_req_cnt.
7765
7766sc1_http_req_rate
7767sc2_http_req_rate
7768 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7769 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7770 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7771 src_http_req_rate.
7772
7773sc1_inc_gpc0
7774sc2_inc_gpc0
7775 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7776 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7777 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7778 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7779 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7780 when a first ACL was verified :
7781
7782 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7783 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7784 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7785
7786sc1_kbytes_in
7787sc2_kbytes_in
7788 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7789 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7790 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7791 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7792
7793sc1_kbytes_out
7794sc2_kbytes_out
7795 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7796 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7797 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7798 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7799
7800sc1_sess_cnt
7801sc2_sess_cnt
7802 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7803 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7804 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7805 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007806 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007807 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7808
7809sc1_sess_rate
7810sc2_sess_rate
7811 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7812 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7813 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7814 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7815 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007816 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007817
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007818so_id <integer>
7819 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7820
7821src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007822 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7823 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7824 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007825
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007826src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007827src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007828 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7829 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7830 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007831 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007832
7833src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007834src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007835 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7836 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7837 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007838 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007839
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007840src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7841src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7842 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7843 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7844 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7845 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7846 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7847 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7848
7849 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7850 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7851 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7852 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7853 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7854 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7855 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7856
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007857src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007858src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007859 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7860 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7861 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007862 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007863
7864src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007865src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007866 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7867 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7868 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007869 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007870
7871src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007872src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007873 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7874 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7875 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007876 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007877
7878src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007879src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007880 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7881 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7882 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007883 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007884
7885src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007886src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007887 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7888 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7889 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007890 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007891
7892src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007893src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007894 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7895 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7896 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7897 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007898 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007899
7900src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007901src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007902 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7903 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7904 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007905 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007906
7907src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007908src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007909 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7910 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7911 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7912 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007913 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007914
7915src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007916src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007917 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7918 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7919 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7920 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7921 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7922 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7923
7924 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7925 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007926 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007927
7928src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007929src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007930 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7931 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7932 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7933 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007934 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007935
7936src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007937src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007938 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7939 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7940 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7941 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007942 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007943
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007944src_port <integer>
7945 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007946
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007947src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007948src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007949 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7950 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7951 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7952 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007953 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007954
7955src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007956src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007957 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7958 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7959 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7960 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007961 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007962
7963src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007964src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007965 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007966 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7967 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007968 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7969 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7970 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007971 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007972
7973 Example :
7974 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7975 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7976 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7977 listen ssh
7978 bind :22
7979 mode tcp
7980 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007981 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007982 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7983 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7984
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007985srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007986 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7987 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7988 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7989 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7990
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007991srv_id <integer>
7992 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7993
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007994srv_is_up(<server>)
7995srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7996 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7997 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7998 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7999 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8000 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8001 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8002 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8003 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8004
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008005table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008006table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008007 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8008 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8009
8010table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008011table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008012 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8013 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8014 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8015
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008016
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020080177.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8018---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008019
8020A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8021during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008022through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8023keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008024
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008025is_ssl
8026 Returns true when the incoming connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
8027 and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared with
8028 a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8029
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008030rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8031 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8032 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8033 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008034 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8035 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8036 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008037
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008038req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008039 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008040 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8041 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8042 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8043 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8044 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8045 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8046
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008047req_proto_http
8048 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8049 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008050 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008051 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8052 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8053
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008054req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008055req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008056 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8057 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8058 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8059 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8060 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8061 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8062 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8063 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8064
8065req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008066req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008067 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8068 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8069 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8070 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8071 cookies.
8072
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008073req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8074 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8075 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8076 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008077 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8078 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8079 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008080
8081req_ssl_sni <string>
8082 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8083 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8084 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8085 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8086 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8087 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8088 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008089 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8090 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
8091 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
8092 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008093
8094 Examples :
8095 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8096 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8097 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8098 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8099 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8100
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008101req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8102 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8103 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8104 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8105 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8106 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8107 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008108 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8109 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
8110 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
8111 option.
8112
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008113ssl_has_sni
8114 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8115 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer. Returns true
8116 when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires that
8117 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8118
8119ssl_sni <string>
8120 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8121 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8122 the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8123 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8124 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8125 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. See also ssl_sni_end
8126 and ssl_sni_req below. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8127 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8128
8129ssl_sni_end <string>
8130 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8131 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8132 the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8133 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8134 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8135 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8136 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8137
8138ssl_sni_req <regex>
8139 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8140 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8141 the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8142 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8143 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8144 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8145 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008146
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008147wait_end
8148 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8149 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8150 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8151 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8152 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8153 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8154 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8155 inspection.
8156
8157 Examples :
8158 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8159 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8160 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8161
8162 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8163 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8164 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8165 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8166 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8167 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8168 tcp-request content reject
8169
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081717.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8172--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008173
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008174A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008175application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8176read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8177than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8178
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008179base <string>
8180 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8181 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8182 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8183 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8184 See also "path" and "uri".
8185
8186base_beg <string>
8187 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8188 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8189 "path_beg".
8190
8191base_dir <string>
8192 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8193 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8194 "path_dir" instead.
8195
8196base_dom <string>
8197 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8198 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8199 instead.
8200
8201base_end <string>
8202 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8203 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8204
8205base_len <integer>
8206 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8207 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8208
8209base_reg <regex>
8210 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8211 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8212 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8213 and all "base_" criteria.
8214
8215base_sub <string>
8216 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8217 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8218 also "base_dir".
8219
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008220cook(<name>) <string>
8221 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8222 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8223 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8224 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8225 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8226 sent by the server.
8227
8228 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8229 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8230 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8231
8232 cook(profile) silver gold
8233
8234cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8235 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8236 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8237 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8238
8239cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8240 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8241 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8242 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8243 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8244 server.
8245
8246cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8247 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8248 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8249 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8250 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8251 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8252
8253cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8254 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8255 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8256 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8257 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8258
8259cook_end(<name>) <string>
8260 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8261 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8262 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8263
8264cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8265 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8266 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8267 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8268 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8269 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8270
8271cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8272 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8273 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8274 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8275 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8276 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8277
8278cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8279 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8280 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8281 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8282
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008283cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8284 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8285 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8286 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8287 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8288 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8289
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008290hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008291hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008292 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8293 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8294 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8295 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008296 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8297 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8298 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8299 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8300 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008301
8302 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008303 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008304 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8305
8306 hdr(Connection) -i close
8307
8308hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008309hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008310 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8311 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8312 response headers sent by the server.
8313
8314hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008315hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008316 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8317 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8318 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8319 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8320 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8321 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8322 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8323
8324hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008325hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008326 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8327 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8328 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8329 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8330 headers sent by the server.
8331
8332hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008333hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008334 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8335 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8336 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8337 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8338 server.
8339
8340hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008341hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008342 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8343 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8344 response headers sent by the server.
8345
8346hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008347hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8348 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8349 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8350 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008351 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8352
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008353hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008354hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008355 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8356 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8357 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8358 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8359
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008360hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008361hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008362 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008363 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8364 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8365 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8366 response headers sent by the server.
8367
8368hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008369hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008370 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8371 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8372 response headers sent by the server.
8373
8374hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008375hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008376 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8377 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8378 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8379 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8380
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008381http_auth(<userlist>)
8382http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008383 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8384 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8385 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8386 of specified groups.
8387
8388 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8389
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008390http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008391 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8392 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8393 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8394 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8395
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008396method <string>
8397 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8398 already check for most common methods.
8399
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008400path <string>
8401 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8402 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8403 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8404
8405path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008406 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8407 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008408
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008409path_dir <string>
8410 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8411 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8412 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8413 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8414
8415path_dom <string>
8416 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8417 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8418 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8419
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008420path_end <string>
8421 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8422 control file name extension.
8423
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008424path_len <integer>
8425 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8426 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008428path_reg <regex>
8429 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8430 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8431 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8432
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008433path_sub <string>
8434 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8435 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8436 "path_dir".
8437
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008438payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8439 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8440 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8441 strings.
8442
8443payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8444 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8445 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8446 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8447 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8448 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8449
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008450req_ver <string>
8451 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8452 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8453
8454status <integer>
8455 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8456 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8457 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8458
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008459url <string>
8460 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008461 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008462
8463url_beg <string>
8464 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008465 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8466 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008468url_dir <string>
8469 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8470 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8471 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8472 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8473
8474url_dom <string>
8475 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8476 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8477 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8478
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008479url_end <string>
8480 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8481 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008482
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008483url_ip <address>
8484 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8485 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8486 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008487
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008488url_len <integer>
8489 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8490 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8491
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008492url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008493 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8494 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008495 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008496 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008497
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008498url_reg <regex>
8499 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8500 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008501 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008502
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008503url_sub <string>
8504 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8505 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008506
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008507urlp(<name>) <string>
8508 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8509 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8510
8511 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8512 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8513
8514urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8515 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8516 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8517 protocol scheme.
8518
8519urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8520 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8521 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8522 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8523 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8524
8525urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8526 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8527 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8528 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8529 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8530
8531urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8532 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8533
8534urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008535 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8536 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008537
8538urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8539 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8540 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8541
8542urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8543 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8544 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8545 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8546 "urlp_" criteria.
8547
8548urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8549 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8550 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8551 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8552
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008553urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8554 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8555 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8556 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8557 negative data.
8558
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085607.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8561---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008563Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8564every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008565order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008567ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8568---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008569FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008570HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008571HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8572HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008573HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8574HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8575HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8576HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8577LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008578METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8579METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8580METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8581METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8582METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8583METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008584RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008585REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008586TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008587WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8588---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008589
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085917.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8592----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008594Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8595combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008597 - AND (implicit)
8598 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8599 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008601A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008603 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008605Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8606indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008608For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8609"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8610requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8611is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008613 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8614 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8615 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8616 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008618To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8619and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008621 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8622 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8623 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8624 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008626 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8627 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8628 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8629 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008630
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008631It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8632expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8633be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008634the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008635
8636 The following rule :
8637
8638 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8639 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8640
8641 Can also be written that way :
8642
8643 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8644
8645It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8646to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8647simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8648sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8649good use is the following :
8650
8651 With named ACLs :
8652
8653 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8654 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8655 monitor fail if site_dead
8656
8657 With anonymous ACLs :
8658
8659 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008661See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008662
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008663
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010086647.8. Pattern extraction
8665-----------------------
8666
8667The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8668response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8669for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8670
8671All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8672"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8673begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8674arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8675much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8676equivalent used in ACLs.
8677
8678The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8679
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008680 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8681 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8682 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8683 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8684 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8685 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8686 requested objects by host/path.
8687
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008688 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008689 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8690 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8691 according to RFC 4291.
8692
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008693 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8694 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8695 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008696 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8697 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8698 according to RFC 4291.
8699
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008700 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8701 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8702 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8703 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8704 type integer and only works with such tables.
8705
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008706 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8707 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8708 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8709 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8710 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8711 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8712 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008713 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008714
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008715 is_ssl This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8716 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer,
8717 otherwise zero.
8718
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008719 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
8720 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8721 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8722 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
8723 wiser to use "url" instead.
8724
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008725 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008726 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8727 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8728 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8729 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008730
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008731 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008732 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8733 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8734 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8735 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8736 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8737 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8738 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8739 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008740
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008741 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8742 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8743 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8744 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8745
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008746 ssl_has_sni This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8747 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
8748 and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
8749 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8750 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8751
8752 ssl_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
8753 connection made via an SSL/TLS data layer and locally deciphered
8754 by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching the HTTPS
8755 host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have been
8756 built with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8757
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008758 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
8759 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8760 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8761 keep them in caches. See also "path".
8762
8763 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
8764 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
8765 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
8766 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
8767 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
8768 table for a given source address.
8769
8770 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
8771 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
8772
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008773 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008774 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8775 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8776 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8777 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8778 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008779
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008780 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008781 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8782 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8783 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8784 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008785
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008786 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8787 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8788 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8789 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8790 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8791 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8792 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008793
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008794 Example :
8795 listen tse-farm
8796 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8797 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8798 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8799 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8800 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8801 persist rdp-cookie
8802 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8803 # This is only useful makes sense if
8804 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8805 stick-table type string size 204800
8806 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8807 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8808 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008809
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008810 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8811 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008812
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008813 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008814 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008815 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8816 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8817 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8818 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8819 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8820 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008821
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008822 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008823
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008824 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008825 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8826 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8827 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8828
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008829 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8830 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8831 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8832 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8833 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008834
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008835 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008836
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008837
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008838The currently available list of transformations include :
8839
8840 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8841 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8842 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8843
8844 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8845 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8846 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8847
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008848 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008849 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8850 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8851 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8852 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8853
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088558. Logging
8856----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008857
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008858One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8859provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8860very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8861provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8862state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008863to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008864headers.
8865
8866In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8867about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8868send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8869
8870 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8871 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8872 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8873 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8874 at the termination.
8875
8876The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8877allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8878as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8879while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8880real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8881delay.
8882
8883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088848.1. Log levels
8885---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008886
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008887TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008888source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008889HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8890in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8891track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8892syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8893about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008894
8895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088968.2. Log formats
8897----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008898
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008899HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008900and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8901slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8902options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008903
8904 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8905 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8906 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8907 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8908 extents.
8909
8910 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8911 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8912 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8913 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8914 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8915
8916 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8917 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8918 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8919 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8920 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8921
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008922 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8923 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8924 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8925 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8926
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008927 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008929Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8930specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8931field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8932servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8933always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8934identifier.
8935
8936Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8937 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8938 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8939 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8940 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8941
8942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089438.2.1. Default log format
8944-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008945
8946This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8947as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8948format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8949
8950 Example :
8951 listen www
8952 mode http
8953 log global
8954 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8955
8956 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8957 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8958 (www/HTTP)
8959
8960 Field Format Extract from the example above
8961 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8962 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8963 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8964 4 'to' to
8965 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8966 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8967
8968Detailed fields description :
8969 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8970 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8971 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8972 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8973 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8974 and processed the connection.
8975 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8976
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008977In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8978"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8979connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8980
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008981It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8982will eventually disappear.
8983
8984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089858.2.2. TCP log format
8986---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008987
8988The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8989is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8990information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8991counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8992emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8993environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8994the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8995sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008996specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8997not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8998fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8999marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009000
9001 Example :
9002 frontend fnt
9003 mode tcp
9004 option tcplog
9005 log global
9006 default_backend bck
9007
9008 backend bck
9009 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9010
9011 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9012 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9013 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9014
9015 Field Format Extract from the example above
9016 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9017 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9018 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9019 4 frontend_name fnt
9020 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9021 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9022 7 bytes_read* 212
9023 8 termination_state --
9024 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9025 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9026
9027Detailed fields description :
9028 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009029 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9030 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9031 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9032 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9033 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009034
9035 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009036 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9037 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9038 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009039
9040 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9041 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9042 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9043 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9044
9045 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9046 and processed the connection.
9047
9048 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9049 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9050 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9051 applications.
9052
9053 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9054 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9055 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9056 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9057 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9058
9059 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9060 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9061 See "Timers" below for more details.
9062
9063 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9064 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9065 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9066 "Timers" below for more details.
9067
9068 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9069 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9070 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9071 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9072 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9073 details.
9074
9075 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9076 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9077 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9078 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9079 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9080
9081 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9082 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9083 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9084 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9085 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9086 for more details.
9087
9088 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009089 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009090 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9091 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9092 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009093 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009094
9095 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9096 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9097 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9098 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9099 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9100 caused by a denial of service attack.
9101
9102 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9103 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9104 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9105 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9106 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9107 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9108 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9109 denial of service attack.
9110
9111 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9112 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9113 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9114 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9115 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9116 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9117 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9118 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9119 be processed than on other servers.
9120
9121 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9122 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9123 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9124 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9125 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9126 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9127 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9128 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9129 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9130 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9131 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9132 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9133 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9134
9135 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9136 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9137 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9138 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9139 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9140 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9141 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9142 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9143
9144 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9145 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9146 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9147 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9148 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9149 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9150 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9151 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9152 occurs.
9153
9154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091558.2.3. HTTP log format
9156----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009157
9158The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9159is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9160the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9161are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9162emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9163generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9164"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9165which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009166frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9167is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009168
9169Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9170slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9171with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9172
9173 Example :
9174 frontend http-in
9175 mode http
9176 option httplog
9177 log global
9178 default_backend bck
9179
9180 backend static
9181 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9182
9183 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9184 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9185 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009186 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009187
9188 Field Format Extract from the example above
9189 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9190 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9191 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9192 4 frontend_name http-in
9193 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9194 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9195 7 status_code 200
9196 8 bytes_read* 2750
9197 9 captured_request_cookie -
9198 10 captured_response_cookie -
9199 11 termination_state ----
9200 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9201 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9202 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9203 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9204 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009205
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009206
9207Detailed fields description :
9208 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009209 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9210 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9211 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9212 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9213 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009214
9215 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009216 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9217 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9218 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009219
9220 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9221 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9222 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9223 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9224 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9225
9226 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9227 and processed the connection.
9228
9229 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9230 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9231 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9232
9233 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9234 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9235 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9236 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9237 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9238 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9239
9240 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9241 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9242 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9243 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9244 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9245 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9246
9247 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9248 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9249 See "Timers" below for more details.
9250
9251 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9252 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9253 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9254 below for more details.
9255
9256 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9257 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9258 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9259 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9260 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9261 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9262 for more details.
9263
9264 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9265 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9266 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9267 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9268 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9269 details.
9270
9271 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9272 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9273 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9274
9275 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9276 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9277 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9278 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9279 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9280 overflowing.
9281
9282 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9283 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9284 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9285 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9286 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9287 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9288 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9289 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9290
9291 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9292 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9293 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9294 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9295 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9296 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9297 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9298 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9299
9300 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9301 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9302 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9303 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9304 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9305 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9306 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9307
9308 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009309 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009310 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9311 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9312 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009313 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009314 system.
9315
9316 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9317 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9318 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9319 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9320 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9321 caused by a denial of service attack.
9322
9323 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9324 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9325 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9326 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9327 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9328 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9329 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9330 denial of service attack.
9331
9332 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9333 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9334 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9335 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9336 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9337 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9338 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9339 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9340 processed than on other servers.
9341
9342 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9343 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9344 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9345 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9346 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9347 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9348 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9349 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9350 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9351 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9352 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9353 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9354 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9355
9356 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9357 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9358 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9359 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9360 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9361 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9362 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9363 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9364
9365 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9366 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9367 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9368 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9369 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9370 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9371 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9372 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9373 occurs.
9374
9375 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9376 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9377 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9378 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9379 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9380 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9381 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9382 cookies" below for more details.
9383
9384 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9385 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9386 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9387 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9388 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9389 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9390 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9391 and cookies" below for more details.
9392
9393 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9394 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9395 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9396 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9397 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9398 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9399 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9400 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9401
9402
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020094038.2.4. Custom log format
9404------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009405
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009406The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9407mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009408
9409HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9410Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9411separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9412prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9413
9414Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9415variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9416string formats ("Q").
9417
9418Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9419HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9420
9421Flags are :
9422 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009423 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009424
9425 Example:
9426
9427 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9428 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9429
9430At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9431
9432 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009433 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009434
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009435the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009436
9437 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009438 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009439 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9440
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009441and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9442
9443 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9444 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9445
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009446Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9447
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009448 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9449 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9450 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9451 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9452 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9453 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009454 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009455 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009456 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009457 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009458 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9459 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9460 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009461 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009462 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9463 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9464 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009465 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9466 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9467 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009468 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009469 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9470 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9471 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9472 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9473 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9474 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9475 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009476 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009477 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9478 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9479 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9480 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9481 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9482 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9483 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9484 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009485 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009486 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9487 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9488 | | %s | server_name | string |
9489 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9490 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9491 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009492 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009493 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009494 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009495 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009496
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009497*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094998.3. Advanced logging options
9500-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009501
9502Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9503just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9504options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9505for more information about their usage.
9506
9507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095088.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9509------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009510
9511It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9512haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9513commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9514monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9515ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9516
9517 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9518 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9519 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9520 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9521
9522 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9523 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9524 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9525 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9526 such as other load-balancers.
9527
9528 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9529 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9530 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9531
9532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095338.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9534----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009535
9536The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9537what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9538or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9539"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9540just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9541log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9542after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9543is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9544with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9545with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9546
9547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095488.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9549------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009550
9551Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9552for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9553"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9554retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9555raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9556a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9557file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9558you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9559"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9560
9561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095628.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9563--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009564
9565Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9566multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9567them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9568"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9569logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9570error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9571and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9572too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9573useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9574alternative.
9575
9576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095778.4. Timing events
9578------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009579
9580Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9581reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9582the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9583frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9584mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9585
9586 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9587 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9588 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9589 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9590 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9591
9592 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9593 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9594 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9595 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9596 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9597
9598 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9599 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9600 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9601 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9602 connection never established.
9603
9604 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9605 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9606 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9607 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9608 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9609 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9610 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9611 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9612 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9613 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9614 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9615
9616 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9617 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9618 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9619 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9620 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9621
9622 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9623
9624 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9625 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9626 negative.
9627
9628These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9629protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9630that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009631due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009632close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9633session has been aborted on timeout.
9634
9635Most common cases :
9636
9637 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9638 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9639 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9640 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9641 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9642 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9643 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9644 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9645 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009646 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9647 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9648 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009649
9650 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9651 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9652 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9653 of ms on remote networks.
9654
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009655 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9656 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9657 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009658
9659 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9660 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9661 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9662 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9663 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9664 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9665 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9666 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9667 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9668 to the server until another one is released.
9669
9670Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9671
9672 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9673 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9674 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9675
9676 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9677 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9678 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9679
9680 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9681 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9682 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9683 flags.
9684
9685 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9686 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9687 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9688 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9689 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9690 the client connection was maintained open.
9691
9692 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9693 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9694 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9695 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9696
9697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096988.5. Session state at disconnection
9699-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009700
9701TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9702"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
97032-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9704each of which has a special meaning :
9705
9706 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9707 session to terminate :
9708
9709 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9710
9711 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9712 server explicitly refused it.
9713
9714 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9715 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9716 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9717 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9718 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9719 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9720
9721 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9722 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9723 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9724 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9725 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9726
9727 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9728 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9729 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9730 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9731 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9732
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009733 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9734 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9735
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009736 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9737 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9738 backup connections when going up.
9739
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009740 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9741
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009742 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9743 send or receive data.
9744
9745 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9746 send or receive data.
9747
9748 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9749 with nothing left in the buffers.
9750
9751 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9752
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009753 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009754 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9755
9756 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9757 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9758 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9759 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9760 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9761
9762 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9763 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9764
9765 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9766 server (HTTP only).
9767
9768 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9769
9770 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9771 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9772 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9773
9774 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9775 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9776 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9777
9778 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9779
9780 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9781 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9782
9783 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9784 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9785 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9786
9787 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9788 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009789 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9790 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009791
9792 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9793 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9794 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9795 another server.
9796
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009797 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009798 server.
9799
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009800 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9801 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9802 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9803 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9804
9805 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9806 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9807 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9808 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9809
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009810 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9811 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9812 "use-server" rule).
9813
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009814 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9815
9816 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9817 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9818
9819 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9820
9821 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9822 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9823 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9824
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009825 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9826 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9827 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9828 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9829 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9830
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009831 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9832
9833 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9834 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9835
9836 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9837
9838 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9839
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009840The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9841was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009842helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9843starvation, attacks, etc...
9844
9845The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9846alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9847easier finding and understanding.
9848
9849 Flags Reason
9850
9851 -- Normal termination.
9852
9853 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9854 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9855 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9856 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9857
9858 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9859 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9860 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9861 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9862 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9863 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009864
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009865 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9866 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009867 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009868
9869 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9870 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9871 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9872
9873 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9874 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9875 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9876 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9877 the server takes too long to respond.
9878
9879 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9880 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9881 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9882 long a time to respond.
9883
9884 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9885 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9886 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9887 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9888 and the client.
9889
9890 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9891 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9892 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9893 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9894 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9895 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9896
9897 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9898 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009899 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9900 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9901 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9902 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009904 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009905 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9906 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9907 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9908 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9909 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9910
9911 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9912 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9913 503 or 504 here.
9914
9915 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9916 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9917 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9918 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9919 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9920
9921 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9922 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009923 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009924 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9925 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9926
9927 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9928 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9929 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9930 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9931 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9932 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9933 between haproxy and the server.
9934
9935 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9936 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9937 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9938 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9939 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9940 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9941 solution is to fix the application.
9942
9943 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9944 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9945 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9946 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9947 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9948 external attacks.
9949
9950 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9951 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009952 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009953 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9954 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9955
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009956 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9957 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9958 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9959 the client.
9960
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009961 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9962 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9963 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9964 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009965 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9966 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9967 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9968 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9969 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009970
9971 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9972 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9973 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9974 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9975
9976 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9977 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9978 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9979 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9980
9981 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9982 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9983 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9984 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9985
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009986The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9987persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9988important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9989re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9990
9991 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9992
9993 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9994 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9995 set on a GET request.
9996
9997 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9998 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009999 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010000 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10001
10002 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10003 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10004 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10005
10006 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10007 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10008 already got a cookie.
10009
10010 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10011 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10012 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10013 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10014 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10015
10016 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10017 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10018 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10019
10020 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10021 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10022 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10023
10024 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10025 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10026
10027 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10028 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10029 then advertised in the response.
10030
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100328.6. Non-printable characters
10033-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010034
10035In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10036consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10037converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10038prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10039being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10040escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10041is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10042'}' when logging headers.
10043
10044Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10045issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10046containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10047
10048Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10049the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10050performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10051
10052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100538.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10054---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010055
10056Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10057achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010058section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010059cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10060the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10061the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010062locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010063not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10064user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10065a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10066wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10067
10068 Examples :
10069 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10070 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10071
10072 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10073 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10074
10075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100768.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10077---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010078
10079Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10080proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10081the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10082server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10083
10084Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10085response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010086section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010087
10088It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010089time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10090appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010091are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10092and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10093follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10094request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10095in the logs.
10096
10097 Example :
10098 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10099 listen proxy-out
10100 mode http
10101 option httplog
10102 option logasap
10103 log global
10104 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10105
10106 # log the name of the virtual server
10107 capture request header Host len 20
10108
10109 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10110 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10111
10112 # log the beginning of the referrer
10113 capture request header Referer len 20
10114
10115 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10116 capture response header Server len 20
10117
10118 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10119 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10120
10121 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10122 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10123
10124 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10125 capture response header Via len 20
10126
10127 # log the URL location during a redirection
10128 capture response header Location len 20
10129
10130 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10131 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10132 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10133 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10134 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10135
10136 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10137 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10138 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10139 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010140 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010141
10142 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10143 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10144 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10145 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10146 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010147 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010148
10149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101508.9. Examples of logs
10151---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010152
10153These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10154them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10155reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10156
10157 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10158 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10159 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10160
10161 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10162 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10163
10164 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10165 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10166 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10167
10168 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10169 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10170
10171 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10172 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10173 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10174
10175 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010176 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010177 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10178 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10179
10180 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10181 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10182 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10183
10184 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10185 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010186 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010187 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10188 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10189 to return the 502 and not the server.
10190
10191 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010192 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010193
10194 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10195 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10196 Nothing was sent to any server.
10197
10198 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10199 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10200
10201 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10202 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10203 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10204 send a 408 return code to the client.
10205
10206 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10207 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10208
10209 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10210 5 seconds ("c----").
10211
10212 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10213 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010214 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010215
10216 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010217 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010218 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10219 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10220 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10221 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10222 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010223
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102259. Statistics and monitoring
10226----------------------------
10227
10228It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10229mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10230CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10231Unix socket.
10232
10233
102349.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010235---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010236
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010237The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10238page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10239
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010240 0. pxname: proxy name
10241 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10242 for server)
10243 2. qcur: current queued requests
10244 3. qmax: max queued requests
10245 4. scur: current sessions
10246 5. smax: max sessions
10247 6. slim: sessions limit
10248 7. stot: total sessions
10249 8. bin: bytes in
10250 9. bout: bytes out
10251 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010252 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010253 12. ereq: request errors
10254 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010255 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010256 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10257 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010258 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010259 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10260 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10261 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10262 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10263 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10264 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10265 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10266 25. qlimit: queue limit
10267 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10268 27. iid: unique proxy id
10269 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10270 29. throttle: warm up status
10271 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10272 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010273 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010274 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10275 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10276 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010277 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010278 UNK -> unknown
10279 INI -> initializing
10280 SOCKERR -> socket error
10281 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10282 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10283 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10284 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10285 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10286 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10287 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10288 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10289 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10290 disable-on-404
10291 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10292 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10293 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010294 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10295 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010296 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10297 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10298 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10299 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10300 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10301 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010302 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10303 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10304 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10305 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010306 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10307 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010308
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103109.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010311-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010312
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010313The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010314must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10315is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10316a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10317risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10318followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10319given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10320then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10321to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010322
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010323It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10324on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10325own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010326
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010327clear counters
10328 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10329 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10330 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10331 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10332 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10333
10334clear counters all
10335 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10336 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10337 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10338
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010339clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10340 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10341
10342 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10343 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10344 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10345 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10346 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10347 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10348
10349 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10350
10351 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10352 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10353 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10354 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10355 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10356 the ACLs :
10357
10358 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10359 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10360 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10361 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10362 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10363 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10364
10365 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010366 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10367 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010368
10369 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010370 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010371 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010372 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10373 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10374 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10375 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010376
10377 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10378
10379 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010380 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010381 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10382 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010383 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10384 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10385 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010386
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010387disable frontend <frontend>
10388 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10389 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10390 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10391 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10392 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10393 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10394 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10395 on the stats page.
10396
10397 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10398 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10399
10400 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10401 level "admin".
10402
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010403disable server <backend>/<server>
10404 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10405 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10406 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10407 during the maintenance.
10408
10409 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10410 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10411
10412 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010413 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010414
10415 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10416 level "admin".
10417
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010418enable frontend <frontend>
10419 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10420 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10421 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10422 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10423 which was disabled.
10424
10425 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10426 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10427
10428 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10429 level "admin".
10430
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010431enable server <backend>/<server>
10432 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10433 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10434
10435 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010436 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010437
10438 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10439 level "admin".
10440
10441get weight <backend>/<server>
10442 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10443 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10444 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10445 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10446 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010447 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010448
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010449help
10450 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10451 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010452
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010453prompt
10454 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10455 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10456 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10457 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10458 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10459 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10460 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10461 command.
10462
10463quit
10464 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010465
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010466set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10467 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10468 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10469 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10470 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10471 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10472 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10473 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10474
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010475set maxconn global <maxconn>
10476 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10477 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10478 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10479 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10480 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10481 setting.
10482
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010483set rate-limit connections global <value>
10484 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10485 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10486 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10487 is passed in number of connections per second.
10488
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020010489set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
10490 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
10491 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
10492 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
10493 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
10494 IP address or affect its quality of service.
10495
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010496set timeout cli <delay>
10497 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10498 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10499 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10500
10501set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10502 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10503 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10504 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10505 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10506 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10507 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10508 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10509 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10510 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10511 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10512 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10513 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10514 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010515 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010516
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010517show errors [<iid>]
10518 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10519 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010520 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10521 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10522 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010523
10524 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10525 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10526 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10527 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10528 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10529 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10530 are reported too.
10531
10532 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10533 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10534 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10535 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10536 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10537 code.
10538
10539 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10540 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10541 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10542 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10543 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10544 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10545 line.
10546
10547 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010548 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10549 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010550 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10551 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10552
10553 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10554 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10555 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10556 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10557 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10558 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10559 00204+ minal\r\n
10560 00211 \r\n
10561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010562 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010563 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10564 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10565 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10566 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10567 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10568 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010569
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010570show info
10571 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10572
10573show sess
10574 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010575 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10576 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10577
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010578show sess <id>
10579 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10580 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10581 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10582 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10583 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10584 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010585
10586show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10587 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10588 possible to dump only selected items :
10589 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10590 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10591 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10592 for example:
10593 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10594 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10595 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10596
10597 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010598 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10599 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010600 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10601 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10602 Nbproc: 1
10603 Process_num: 1
10604 (...)
10605
10606 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10607 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10608 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10609 (...)
10610 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10611
10612 $
10613
10614 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10615 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10616 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10617 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010618 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010619
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010620show table
10621 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10622 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10623 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10624 entries currently in use.
10625
10626 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010627 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010628 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10629 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010630
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010631show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010632 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10633 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10634 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010635 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10636
10637 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10638 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10639 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10640 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10641 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10642
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010643 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10644 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10645 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10646 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10647 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10648 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10649
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010650
10651 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010652 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10653 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010654
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010655 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010656 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010657 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010658 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10659 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10660 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10661 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010662
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010663 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010664 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010665 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10666 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010667
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010668 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10669 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010670 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010671 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10672 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010673
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010674 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10675 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010676 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010677 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10678 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10679
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010680 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10681 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10682 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10683 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10684 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10685
10686 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10687 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10688 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010689 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10690 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010691 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10692 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010693
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010694shutdown frontend <frontend>
10695 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10696 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10697 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10698 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10699 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10700 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10701 once it is terminated.
10702
10703 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10704 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10705
10706 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10707 level "admin".
10708
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010709shutdown session <id>
10710 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10711 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10712 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10713 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10714 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10715 flag in the logs.
10716
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010717shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10718 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10719 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10720 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10721 'K' flag in the logs.
10722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010723/*
10724 * Local variables:
10725 * fill-column: 79
10726 * End:
10727 */